Alvarion Network Router 214486 User Manual

BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi²  
System Manual  
SW Version 4.3.4  
March 2007  
P/N 214486  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal Rights  
Legal Rights  
© Copyright 2007 Alvarion Ltd. All rights reserved.  
The material contained herein is proprietary, privileged, and confidential and  
owned by Alvarion or its third party licensors. No disclosure thereof shall be made  
to third parties without the express written permission of Alvarion Ltd.  
Alvarion Ltd. reserves the right to alter the equipment specifications and  
descriptions in this publication without prior notice. No part of this publication  
shall be deemed to be part of any contract or warranty unless specifically  
incorporated by reference into such contract or warranty.  
Trade Names  
®
®
®
®
®
®
Alvarion , BreezeCOM , WALKair , WALKnet , BreezeNET , BreezeACCESS ,  
®
BreezeMANAGE , BreezeLINK , BreezeConfig , BreezeMAX , AlvariSTAR ,  
BreezeLITE , AlvariCRAFT , MGW , eMGW and/or other products and/or  
services referenced here in are either registered trademarks, trademarks or  
service marks of Alvarion Ltd.  
All other names are or may be the trademarks of their respective owners.  
Statement of Conditions  
The information contained in this manual is subject to change without notice.  
Alvarion Ltd. shall not be liable for errors contained herein or for incidental or  
consequential damages in connection with the furnishing, performance, or use of  
this manual or equipment supplied with it.  
Warranties and Disclaimers  
All Alvarion Ltd. ("Alvarion") products purchased from Alvarion or through any of  
Alvarion's authorized resellers are subject to the following warranty and product  
liability terms and conditions.  
Exclusive Warranty  
(a) Alvarion warrants that the Product hardware it supplies and the tangible  
media on which any software is installed, under normal use and conditions, will  
be free from significant defects in materials and workmanship for a period of  
fourteen (14) months from the date of shipment of a given Product to Purchaser  
(the "Warranty Period"). Alvarion will, at its sole option and as Purchaser's sole  
remedy, repair or replace any defective Product in accordance with Alvarion'  
standard R&R procedure.  
(b) With respect to the Firmware, Alvarion warrants the correct functionality  
according to the attached documentation, for a period of fourteen (14) month from  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal Rights  
invoice date (the "Warranty Period")". During the Warranty Period, Alvarion may  
release to its Customers firmware updates, which include additional performance  
improvements and/or bug fixes, upon availability (the "Warranty"). Bug fixes,  
temporary patches and/or workarounds may be supplied as Firmware updates.  
Additional hardware, if required, to install or use Firmware updates must be  
purchased by the Customer. Alvarion will be obligated to support solely the two (2)  
most recent Software major releases.  
ALVARION SHALL NOT BE LIABLE UNDER THIS WARRANTY IF ITS TESTING  
AND EXAMINATION DISCLOSE THAT THE ALLEGED DEFECT IN THE PRODUCT  
DOES NOT EXIST OR WAS CAUSED BY PURCHASER'S OR ANY THIRD  
PERSON'S MISUSE, NEGLIGENCE, IMPROPER INSTALLATION OR IMPROPER  
TESTING, UNAUTHORIZED ATTEMPTS TO REPAIR, OR ANY OTHER CAUSE  
BEYOND THE RANGE OF THE INTENDED USE, OR BY ACCIDENT, FIRE,  
LIGHTNING OR OTHER HAZARD.  
Disclaimer  
(a) THE SUPPLIED UNITS SUPPORT 802.11 b/g ONLY.  
(b) The Software is sold on an "AS IS" basis. Alvarion, its affiliates or its licensors  
MAKE NO WARRANTIES, WHATSOEVER, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,  
WITH RESPECT TO THE SOFTWARE AND THE ACCOMPANYING  
DOCUMENTATION. ALVARION SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ALL IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
PURPOSE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT WITH RESPECT TO THE SOFTWARE.  
UNITS OF PRODUCT (INCLUDING ALL THE SOFTWARE) DELIVERED TO  
PURCHASER HEREUNDER ARE NOT FAULT-TOLERANT AND ARE NOT  
DESIGNED, MANUFACTURED OR INTENDED FOR USE OR RESALE IN  
APPLICATIONS WHERE THE FAILURE, MALFUNCTION OR INACCURACY OF  
PRODUCTS CARRIES A RISK OF DEATH OR BODILY INJURY OR SEVERE  
PHYSICAL OR ENVIRONMENTAL DAMAGE ("HIGH RISK ACTIVITIES"). HIGH  
RISK ACTIVITIES MAY INCLUDE, BUT ARE NOT LIMITED TO, USE AS PART OF  
ON-LINE CONTROL SYSTEMS IN HAZARDOUS ENVIRONMENTS REQUIRING  
FAIL-SAFE PERFORMANCE, SUCH AS IN THE OPERATION OF NUCLEAR  
FACILITIES, AIRCRAFT NAVIGATION OR COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS, AIR  
TRAFFIC CONTROL, LIFE SUPPORT MACHINES, WEAPONS SYSTEMS OR  
OTHER APPLICATIONS REPRESENTING A SIMILAR DEGREE OF POTENTIAL  
HAZARD. ALVARION SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  
WARRANTY OF FITNESS FOR HIGH RISK ACTIVITIES.  
(c) PURCHASER'S SOLE REMEDY FOR BREACH OF THE EXPRESS  
WARRANTIES ABOVE SHALL BE REPLACEMENT OR REFUND OF THE  
PURCHASE PRICE AS SPECIFIED ABOVE, AT ALVARION'S OPTION. TO THE  
iv  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal Rights  
FULLEST EXTENT ALLOWED BY LAW, THE WARRANTIES AND REMEDIES SET  
FORTH IN THIS AGREEMENT ARE EXCLUSIVE AND IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER  
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, EITHER IN FACT OR BY  
OPERATION OF LAW, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, INCLUDING BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO WARRANTIES, TERMS OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY,  
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, SATISFACTORY QUALITY,  
CORRESPONDENCE WITH DESCRIPTION, NON-INFRINGEMENT, AND  
ACCURACY OF INFORMATION GENERATED. ALL OF WHICH ARE EXPRESSLY  
DISCLAIMED. ALVARION' WARRANTIES HEREIN RUN ONLY TO PURCHASER,  
AND ARE NOT EXTENDED TO ANY THIRD PARTIES. ALVARION NEITHER  
ASSUMES NOR AUTHORIZES ANY OTHER PERSON TO ASSUME FOR IT ANY  
OTHER LIABILITY IN CONNECTION WITH THE SALE, INSTALLATION,  
MAINTENANCE OR USE OF ITS PRODUCTS.  
Limitation of Liability  
(a) ALVARION SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO THE PURCHASER OR TO ANY THIRD  
PARTY, FOR ANY LOSS OF PROFITS, LOSS OF USE, INTERRUPTION OF  
BUSINESS OR FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, PUNITIVE OR  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, WHETHER ARISING UNDER  
BREACH OF CONTRACT, TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), STRICT LIABILITY  
OR OTHERWISE AND WHETHER BASED ON THIS AGREEMENT OR  
OTHERWISE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.  
(b) TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN NO EVENT SHALL  
THE LIABILITY FOR DAMAGES HEREUNDER OF ALVARION OR ITS EMPLOYEES  
OR AGENTS EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE PAID FOR THE PRODUCT BY  
PURCHASER, NOR SHALL THE AGGREGATE LIABILITY FOR DAMAGES TO ALL  
PARTIES REGARDING ANY PRODUCT EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE PAID  
FOR THAT PRODUCT BY THAT PARTY (EXCEPT IN THE CASE OF A BREACH OF  
A PARTY'S CONFIDENTIALITY OBLIGATIONS).  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal Rights  
Outdoor Unit and Antenna Installation and Grounding  
Ensure that outdoor units, antennas and supporting structures are properly  
installed to eliminate any physical hazard to either people or property. Make sure  
that the installation of the outdoor unit, antenna and cables is performed in  
accordance with all relevant national and local building and safety codes. Even  
where grounding is not mandatory according to applicable regulation and national  
codes, it is highly recommended to ensure that the outdoor unit and the antenna  
mast (when using external antenna) are grounded and suitable lightning  
protection devices are used so as to provide protection against voltage surges and  
static charges. In any event, Alvarion is not liable for any injury, damage or  
regulation violations associated with or caused by installation, grounding or  
lightning protection.  
Disposal of Electronic and Electrical Waste  
Disposal of Electronic and Electrical Waste  
Pursuant to the WEEE EU Directive electronic and electrical waste must not be disposed of with  
unsorted waste. Please contact your local recycling authority for disposal of this product.  
vi  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal Rights  
Important Notice  
This user manual is delivered subject to the following conditions and restrictions:  
This manual contains proprietary information belonging to Alvarion Ltd. Such  
information is supplied solely for the purpose of assisting properly authorized  
users of the respective Alvarion products.  
No part of its contents may be used for any other purpose, disclosed to any  
person or firm or reproduced by any means, electronic and mechanical,  
without the express prior written permission of Alvarion Ltd.  
The text and graphics are for the purpose of illustration and reference only.  
The specifications on which they are based are subject to change without  
notice.  
The software described in this document is furnished under a license. The  
software may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of that  
license.  
Information in this document is subject to change without notice.  
Corporate and individual names and data used in examples herein are  
fictitious unless otherwise noted.  
Alvarion Ltd. reserves the right to alter the equipment specifications and  
descriptions in this publication without prior notice. No part of this  
publication shall be deemed to be part of any contract or warranty unless  
specifically incorporated by reference into such contract or warranty.  
The information contained herein is merely descriptive in nature, and does not  
constitute an offer for the sale of the product described herein.  
Any changes or modifications of equipment, including opening of the  
equipment not expressly approved by Alvarion Ltd. will void equipment  
warranty and any repair thereafter shall be charged for. It could also void the  
user's authority to operate the equipment.  
Some of the equipment provided by Alvarion and specified in this manual, is  
manufactured and warranted by third parties. All such equipment must be  
installed and handled in full compliance with the instructions provided by such  
manufacturers as attached to this manual or provided thereafter by Alvarion or  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal Rights  
the manufacturers. Non-compliance with such instructions may result in serious  
damage and/or bodily harm and/or void the user's authority to operate the  
equipment and/or revoke the warranty provided by such manufacturer.  
viii  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compliances  
Compliances  
NOTE  
This section provides regulatory compliance details for the Access Point unit of the system. Refer to  
the relevant manual for compliance details of the SU-ODU unit.  
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B  
digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential  
installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency  
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may  
cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no  
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this  
equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which  
can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to  
try to correct the interference by one of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which  
the receiver is connected  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help  
FCC Caution: Any changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate this  
equipment. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is  
subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired operation.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compliances  
IMPORTANT NOTE: FCC Radiation Exposure Statement  
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an  
uncontrolled environment. This equipment should be installed and operated with  
a minimum distance of 20 centimeters (8 inches) between the radiator and your  
body. This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with  
any other antenna or transmitter.  
EC Conformance Declaration  
Marking by the above symbol indicates compliance with the Essential  
Requirements of the R&TTE Directive of the European Union (1999/5/EC). This  
equipment meets the following conformance standards:  
EN 60950 (IEC 60950) - Product Safety  
EN 300 328 - Technical requirements for 2.4 GHz radio equipment  
EN 301 489-1 / EN 301 489-17 - EMC requirements for radio equipment  
Countries of Operation & Conditions of Use in the European Community  
This device is intended to be operated in all countries of the European  
Community. Requirements for outdoor operation, license requirements and  
allowed channels of operation apply in some countries as described below:  
NOTE  
The user must use the configuration utility provided with this product to ensure the channels of  
operation are in conformance with the spectrum usage rules for European Community countries as  
described below.  
This device requires that the user or installer properly enter the current  
country of operation in the command line interface as described in the user  
guide, before operating this device.  
This device will automatically limit the allowable channels determined by the  
current country of operation. Incorrectly entering the country of operation may  
result in illegal operation and may cause harmful interference to other system.  
The user is obligated to ensure the device is operating according to the  
channel limitations, outdoor restrictions and license requirements for each  
European Community country as described in this document.  
This device may be operated in all countries of the European Community  
using the 2.4 GHz band: Channels 1 - 13, except where noted below.  
x
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compliances  
In Italy the end-user must apply for a license from the national spectrum  
authority to operate this device outdoors.  
In Belgium outdoor operation is only permitted using the 2.46 - 2.4835  
GHz band: Channel 13.  
In France outdoor operation is only permitted using the 2.4 - 2.454 GHz  
band: Channels 1 - 7.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About This Manual  
2
2
This manual describes the BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS Wi unit and  
details how to install, operate and manage the access point.  
This manual is intended for technicians responsible for installing, setting and  
2
2
operating the BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS Wi , and for system  
administrators responsible for managing the system.  
This manual contains the following chapters and appendices:  
2
Chapter 1 - Product Description - Describes the Wi unit and its  
functionality.  
2
Chapter 2 - Installation - Describes how to install the Wi and how to  
connect to subscriber’s equipment.  
Chapter 3 - Initial Configuration - Describes how to initially configure the  
access point in order to test basic link operation .  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration- Describes advanced configuration of the  
the access point.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface - Describes the command line interface  
commands for configuring the access point.  
Appendix A - Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
xvi  
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
xvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
xviii  
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
xix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
xx  
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
xxi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
xxii  
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
xxiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
xxiv  
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
2
2
BreezeMAX Wi and BreezeACCESS VL Wi System Manual  
xxv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
Chapter 1 - Product Description  
In This Chapter:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1 - Product Description  
1.1  
Introduction  
Alvarion's Wi² suite of converged solutions, including BreezeMAX Wi²and  
BreezeACCESS Wi²("Wi²"), unites the advantages of the popular WiFi access with  
the powerful capabilities of BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS VL/4900  
(“BreezeACCESS”) systems to provide cost-effective solutions for personal  
broadband services.  
The Wi² system comprises a self-contained combination of an advanced WiFi  
access point and a BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS SU-ODU that provides backhaul  
connectivity. With its advanced roaming software, the Wi² can be deployed almost  
anywhere to provide broadband mobility to standard WiFi (IEEE 802.11 b/g) end  
user devices. Used in conjunction with Alvarion's market-leading BreezeMAX or  
BreezeACCESS base stations, the Wi² can be used to expand the existing  
capabilities of Alvarion's WiMAX and pre-WiMAX networks. Using the Wi², a  
BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS network can be used to provide personal  
broadband services to high-end business as well as residential users equipped  
with WiFi enabled devices such as laptops, PDAs, smart-phones, and portable  
gaming devices. As a converged system, the Wi² also gives operators the ability to  
seamlessly transition to a fully mobile WiMAX network with managed services for  
personal broadband users.  
Operating in both licensed and licensed-exempt frequencies, the Wi² system  
leverages the easy availability of WiFi technology - along with the power and  
robustness of BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS broadband wireless access system -  
to answer critical public and private sector needs such as traffic management,  
video surveillance, public Internet access, homeland security, and various  
nomadic applications.  
The Wi² is a self-contained, robust all-outdoor system that comprises three  
elements:  
A feature-rich WiFi (IEEE 802.11 b/g) Access Point (AP)  
A BreezeMAX/BreezeACCESS VL/BreezeACCESS 4900 SU-ODU (supplied  
separately).  
NOTE  
In a BreezeACCESS VL/4900 backhauling link, an SU-54-BD model should be used.  
2
System Description  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
A power supply module that provides power to both the WiFi AP and the  
SU-ODU.  
The Wi² system requires only a single connection to either AC or DC power. With  
its easy installation and operation, high performance, and rich security and QoS  
feature sets, the Wi² is an ideal solution for operators, municipalities and  
communities looking to build metropolitan broadband networks or to integrate  
WiFi hot zone capabilities into their existing broadband wireless access networks.  
The result is personal broadband services ranging from public Internet access to  
public safety and Intranet applications.  
NOTE  
This document describes how to install and manage the Wi² system, including the installation and  
connections of a BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS SU-ODU when installed on the mounting plate of  
2
the Wi system. For details on other installation options for the SU-ODU and how to manage it, refer  
to the relevant BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS VL/4900 documents.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1 - Product Description  
1.2  
Specifications  
1.2.1 Radio  
Table 1-1: Radio Specifications  
Item  
Description  
IEEE 802.11b/g  
Radio Type  
802.11b+g, 802.11b only, 802.11g only  
2400-2497 MHz  
Radio Mode  
Frequency Band  
Operating Channels  
ETSI (EUR): 2412 ~ 2472 MHz(CH1-CH13)  
MKK (Japan) 11b: 2412 ~ 2484 MHz (CH1-CH14)  
MKK (Japan) 11g: 2412 ~ 2472 MHz(CH1-CH13)  
France: 2457 ~ 2472 MHz(CH10-CH13)  
20 MHz  
Channel Bandwidth  
Data Rates  
802.11b: 1, 2, 5.5, 11 Mbps  
802.11g: 6, 9, 12, 18, 24, 36, 48, 54 Mbps  
Dynamic (CH6)  
Turbo Mode (802.11g Super G)  
802.11b Radio Technology  
Direct Sequence-Spread Spectrum (DSSS)  
Differential Binary Phase Shift Keying (DBPSK) @ 1 Mbps  
Differential Quadrature Phase Shift Keying (DQPSK) @ 2 Mbps  
Complementary Code Keying (CCK) @ 5.5 and 11 Mbps  
802.11b Modulation Technique  
Orthogonal Frequency Divisional Multiplexing (OFDM)  
802.11g Radio Technology  
Binary Phase Shift Keying (BPSK) @ 6 and 9 Mbps  
Quadrature Phase Shift Keying (QPSK) @ 12 and 18 Mbps  
16-Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (QAM) @ 24 & 36 Mbps  
64-QAM @ 48 & 54 Mbps  
802.11g Modulation Technique  
1/2 2/3, 3/4  
FEC Coding Rates  
Max Tx Power  
6 to 24 Mbps: 20dBm.  
36 and 48 Mbps:19dBm.  
54 Mbps: 18dBm  
802.11b for all frequencies and all rates: 20dBm.  
100%, 50%, 25%, 12.5%, Min.  
2 x N-Type, 50 ohm  
TPC (Transmit Power Control)  
Antenna Ports  
Rx antenna switching by energy sensing  
Antenna Diversity  
4
System Description  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Specifications  
1.2.2 Sensitivity  
Table 1-2: Sensitivity  
Sensitivity (dBm)  
Data Rate  
802.11b, 1 Mbps  
802.11b, 2 Mbps  
802.11b, 5.5 Mbps  
802.11b, 11 Mbps  
802.11g, 6 Mbps  
802.11g, 9 Mbps  
802.11g, 12 Mbps  
802.11g, 18 Mbps  
802.11g, 24 Mbps  
802.11g, 36 Mbps  
802.11g, 48 Mbps  
802.11g, 54 Mbps  
-96  
-93  
-93  
-90  
-91  
-90  
-89  
-88  
-84  
-80  
-75  
-73  
1.2.3 8 dBi Omni Antenna  
Table 1-3: 8 dBi Omni Antenna  
Item  
Description  
8 dBi  
Antenna gain  
VSWR  
2:1 max  
Linear Vertical  
Antenna Polarization  
Horizontal Plane  
Vertical Plane  
Dimensions  
Weight  
360°  
15°  
52 cm x 1.9 cm diameter  
340 g  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 1 - Product Description  
1.2.4 Configuration and Management  
Table 1-4: Configuration and Management  
Item  
Description  
Management options  
Web-based (HTTP/HTTPS)  
Telnet  
SSH  
SNMP  
V1 / V2c, supports 802.11 MIB, RFC-1213 MIB II and private MIB.  
SNMP agent  
Management access  
Local via Console port  
From the backhaul network  
From WiFi clients  
Access Password  
Management access protection  
Enable/Disable access from wireless clients  
Enable/Disable access using web/Telnet/SNMP  
Restrict access to authorized stations (by IP)  
Local/RADIUS MAC List  
WiFi Clients Authentication  
Encryption  
IEEE 802.1x  
WEP  
WPA/TKIP over 802.1x or PSK (Pre-shared Key)  
802.11i / WPA2 (AES-CCMP) over 802.1x or PSK  
Mixed WPA and WEP clients support  
Configurable or automatic (DHCP client)  
Four QoS levels using the WMM standard according to IEEE 802.11e  
HTTP/FTP/TFTP  
Allocation of IP parameters  
WiFi Multi-Media Support  
Software upgrade  
FTP/TFTP  
Configuration Upload/Download  
6
System Description  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Specifications  
1.2.5 Mechanical  
Table 1-5: Mechanical Specifications  
Item  
Description  
240mm (W) X 261mm (H) X 171mm (D)  
Dimensions (excluding mounting plate  
and connectors)  
4.85 Kg  
0.7 Kg  
Weight (excluding antennas, backhauling  
CPE and mounting plate )  
Weight of Mounting Plate  
AC Power Supply  
85-260VAC, 47-63Hz, maximum power consumption 2.5A  
0
+/- 15  
Mounting Plate Tilt  
0
+/- 45  
Mounting Plate Rotation  
1.2.6 Electrical  
Table 1-6: Electrical Specifications  
Type  
Details  
85-260VAC, 47-63Hz, maximum power consumption 2.5A  
42 VDC to 60 VDC, maximum power consumption 3.5A  
AC Power Supply  
DC Power supply  
AC/DC Power Switching  
When both AC and DC power sources are connected, AC power input will be  
used as long as internal power supplies are working properly. The unit will switch  
to DC power source if AC power input fails, or the internal power supplies fail,  
and the DC power input is in the proper range.  
1.2.7 Connectors and LEDs  
Table 1-7: Connectors and LEDs  
Type  
AC IN  
SU  
Description  
Connection to AC mains. 3-pin power plug, Bulgin PX0732/S/07  
Ethernet and power connection to backhauling CPE.  
RJ-45, in a weather protected service box  
Ethernet and power connection to AP (PoE).  
AP  
RJ-45, in a weather protected service box  
Connection to DC power source. 2-pin power plug, Bulgin PX0736/S/07  
Ethernet and power connection, 8-pins DIN jack  
10/100Base-T, half/full duplex with auto-negotiation  
RS232 DTE, 8-pins DIN jack  
DC IN  
PoE  
Console  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 1 - Product Description  
Table 1-7: Connectors and LEDs  
Description  
Type  
LEDs  
Power  
Link (Ethernet link integrity/activity)  
11b/g: 3 LEDs indicating wireless link activity  
8
System Description  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
1.2.8  
Environmental  
Table 1-8: Environmental Specifications  
Item  
Details  
0
0
-40 C to 55 C  
Operating Temperature  
Storage Temperature  
Humidity  
0
0
-40 C to 70 C  
Maximum 95%.  
IP-67  
Water Proof  
IEC 60068-2-5  
Solar Radiation protection  
Salt  
IEC 60068 part 2-52  
ETS 300 019-2-2 Class 2.3 Pubic Transportation  
IEC 68-2-29  
Transportation  
Storage shock  
Storage drop  
Wind operation  
Wind survival  
IEC 68-2-32  
160 Km/hour  
220 Km/hour  
1.2.9 Standards Compliance  
Table 1-9: Standards Compliance  
Type  
EMC  
Standard  
EN55022 CE Class B  
FCC Class B Part 15  
Safety  
UL / CUL (CSA60950-1, UL60950-1)  
CE / CB (EN60950/IEC 60950-1)  
The unit withstand at +4KV of Input surge, 1.2usec rise/fall time, 50µsec duration,  
every 10 seconds, for all interfaces.  
Lightning  
Radio  
ETSI 300 328 (11b/g)  
ETSI 301 489 (DC power)  
FCC Part 15C 15.247/15.207 (11b/g)  
RS210 (Canada)  
TELEC  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.1  
Hardware Description  
The Wi² consists of a WiFi access point with an integrated power supply and  
interface module that connects to either a BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS outdoor  
unit (SU-ODU) for backhaul and network management software. Each unit is  
housed in a weatherproof enclosure for mounting outdoors.  
Antenna Connectors  
(Top Panel)  
s
Mounting  
Plate  
Pole Mounting  
Bracket  
LEDs  
Grounding  
Stud  
Connections  
(Bottom Panel)  
Figure 2-1: Wi² Unit (without SU-ODU)  
NOTE  
The diagram in Figure 2-1 includes a mounting plate for an SU-ODU. (It does not show the actual  
SU-ODU). The SU-ODU can also be installed separately, in which case there is no need to attach  
the mounting plate to the Wi² unit.  
12  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Hardware Description  
2.1.1 Bottom Panel  
Figure 2-2 shows the bottom panel of the Wi² unit and Table 2-1 lists the  
components.  
Power Supply  
and  
Interface Module  
WiFi Access Point  
(AP)  
Figure 2-2: Bottom Panel (without the SU-ODU)  
Table 2-1: Bottom Panel Components  
Element  
Item  
Description  
WiFi Access Point (AP)  
Console Port Cover Holder  
Holder for waterproof protection cover  
for console port when port is not in use.  
Console Port  
PoE Port  
Connection to console port for system  
management.  
An Ethernet cable connects the PoE port  
to the AP port in the Power Supply and  
Interface Module.  
Impermeability Test Screw  
Do not remove or loosen this screw.  
Doing so may impair the sealing of the  
unit against moisture and humidity.  
Power Supply and Interface  
Module  
AC Power Plug  
AP Port  
3-pin power plug for connection to AC  
power source.  
An Ethernet cable connects the AP port  
to the PoE port in the AP.  
SU Port  
Connection to BreezeMAX or  
BreezeACCESS outdoor unit  
DC Power Plug)  
2-pin power plug for connection to DC  
power source.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.1.2 Top Panel  
Figure 2-3: Top Panel (without the SU-ODU)  
Figure 2-3 shows the top panel of the Wi² unit with two N-type RF connectors for  
external antennas.  
2.1.3 LED Indicators  
The Wi² includes eight status LED indicators. Figure 2-4 shows the LEDs and  
Table 2-2 describes the system status.  
Figure 2-4: LED Indicators  
Table 2-2: LED Indicators  
LED  
Status  
Description  
11 b/g (three pairs of LEDs  
A
B
Always on  
Flashing  
Indicates packets received using 802.11b  
modulation.  
14  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Hardware Description  
Table 2-2: LED Indicators  
Status Description  
LED  
C
Flashing  
Indicates packets received using 802.11g  
modulation.  
Power  
Link  
On Green  
On Amber  
On Green  
Indicates that the system is working  
normally.  
Indicates a power shutdown due to a low  
temperature condition.  
Indicates a valid 10/100 Mbps Ethernet  
cable link.  
Flashing  
Green  
Indicates that the Wi² is transmitting or  
receiving data on a 10/100 Mbps Ethernet  
LAN. Flashing rate is proportional to  
network activity.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.2  
Installation Requirements  
This section describes all the supplies required to install the Wi² and the items  
included in each installation package.  
2.2.1 Packing List  
The BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² installation kit includes the following  
components:  
Wi² unit  
SU-ODU mounting plate  
4 sets of M8 x 16 hex head screws + flat washers + spring washers  
4 sets of 1/4” x 1/2” hex head screws + flat washers + spring washers  
4 sets of M6 x 12 hex head screws + flat washers + spring washers  
Cable kit including a 55 cm category 5E Ethernet cable with two shielded  
RJ-45 connectors, one with a metal service box, and a spare shielded RJ-45  
connector.  
AC power connector  
2 x 9/16" (530 mm) metal bands  
3m Ethernet configuration cable (2 pairs, straight)  
2.2.2 Additional/Optional Installation Requirements  
Category 5E cable* for connecting to an SU-ODU if installed separately  
(maximum length 100m.)  
Rubber sealing cap for BreezeMAX or BreezeACCESS HW Revision E ODU  
(supplied with SU-ODU)  
Service Box for BreezeACCESS HW Revision D or lower ODU (supplied with  
SU-ODU).  
16  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Installation Requirements  
Crimping tool for RJ-45 connectors (if connecting to a BreezeACCESS ODU)  
RS232 console cable*  
8 dBi Omnidirectional antenna(s)*  
Sectoral antenna(s), including RF cable with N-Type connector*  
UL/CSA listed smooth circular power cable, 1.5mm to 2.5mm each. Outer  
0
0
diameter 7mm to 9mm, UV resistant, temperatures range -40 C to +65 C min.  
Other specifications (such as oil resistance, no of wires) according to specific  
installation requirements.  
A mains plug for connecting to AC mains  
Two terminal rings if connecting to a DC source  
Grounding cable with an appropriate termination.  
Installation tools and materials, including appropriate means for installing the  
Wi² and antenna(s).  
A PC with an Ethernet NIC for configuring basic parameters of the WiFi AP and  
the SU-ODU, and a b/g WiFi card for testing wireless connectivity to the AP.  
Wall - Tilt Pole Mounting kit* (page 28)  
DC power connector* (pack of 5)  
Waterproof covers for AC/DC socket* (pack of 5)  
NOTE  
Before starting to install the Wi² unit, check that you have all the necessary parts and accessories.  
Optional accessories marked with an asterisk (*) can be ordered from your supplier.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.2.3 Guidelines for Positioning Wi²  
CAUTION  
ONLY experienced installation professionals who are familiar with local building and safety codes  
and, wherever applicable, are licensed by the appropriate government regulatory authorities should  
install outdoor units and antennas.  
Failure to do so may void the product warranty and may expose the end user or Service Provider to  
legal and financial liabilities. Alvarion and its resellers or distributors are not liable for injury, damage  
or regulation violations associated with the installation of Outdoor Units or antennas.  
The Wi² should be mounted vertically on a 2"- 6" pole. Its location should enable  
easy access to the unit and its connectors for installation and maintenance and  
should have a clear or near line of sight to the area to be covered.  
For best performance, the SU-ODU attached to the unit should have clear or near  
line of sight to the base station. For further information about the optimal  
installation location of the SU-ODU refer to the relevant manual.  
18  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation  
2.3  
Installation  
The following sections describe how to install a Wi² unit, including attaching the  
SU-ODU to the mounting plate, attaching the mounting plate to the Wi² unit,  
connecting to the SU-ODU, pole mounting, connecting a grounding cable, and  
connecting the antenna(s).  
2.3.1 Attaching the SU-ODU to the Mounting Plate  
IMPORTANT  
The angle at which the SU-ODU is mounted on the Wi² can be adapted depending on the location  
of the Wi² unit in relation to the Base Station. Once attached, the mounting plate can be tilted either  
up or down. Before attaching the SU-ODU to the mounting plate, determine the direction of the tilt.  
To attach a BreezeMAX PRO-S ODU or BreezeACCESSSU-ODU with HW Revision E  
(octagonal) to the mounting plate:  
NOTE  
BreezeACCESS SU-ODU with HW Revision E is the new, smaller, octagonal ODU available in the  
5.4 and 5.8 GHz bands. BreezeACCESS SU-ODUs with HW Revision D or lower are rectangular  
and slightly larger in size.  
1
2
Determine the tilt direction of the SU-ODU.  
Using the M8 x 16 hex head screws and the flat washers and spring washers  
supplied, attach the SU-ODU to the mounting plate as shown in Figure 2-5 in  
the direction marked.  
3
Tighten the screws. Apply torque of 57 lb*in [6.4 N*m].  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
Figure 2-5: Attaching BreezeMAX PRO-S ODU or BreezeACCESSSU-ODU with HW Revision E to  
Mounting Plate  
NOTE  
For information about polarization refer to the relevant manual.  
To attach a BreezeACCESS SU-ODU with HW Revision D or lower (rectangular) to  
the mounting plate:  
1
2
Determine the tilt direction of the SU-ODU.  
Using the 1/4” x 1/2” hex head screws and the flat washers and spring  
washers supplied, attach the SU-ODU to the mounting plate as shown in  
Figure 2-6 in the direction marked.  
3
Tighten the screws. Apply torque of 57 lb*in [6.4 N*m].  
20  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation  
Figure 2-6: Attaching BreezeACCESS SU-ODU with HW Revision D or lower to Mounting Plate  
NOTE  
Sometimes, physical circumstance require that the SU-ODU be located at a distance from the Wi²  
unit and not attached to the mounting plate. For further information see the section on SU-ODU  
mounting in the relevant manual.  
2.3.2 Attaching the Mounting Plate to the Wi² Unit  
1
Hold the mounting plate with SU-ODU attached so the tilt label faces the tilt  
direction that you have decided upon (see Section 2.3.1).  
2
Using the M6 x 12 hex head screws and the flat washers and spring washers  
supplied, attach the mounting plate to the Wi² unit as shown in Figure 2-7.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
Figure 2-7: Attaching the Mounting Plate to the Wi² Unit  
3
Adjust the tilt angle according to the scale marked on the mounting plate and  
tighten the screws. Apply torque of 57 lb*in [6.4 N*m].  
2.3.3 Connecting the Wi² Unit to the SU-ODU  
NOTE  
The Wi² installation kit includes a Category 5E Ethernet cable, suitable for connecting to  
BreezeMAX PRO-S ODU. For instructions on how to adapt the Ethernet cable for connecting to a  
BreezeACCESS SU-ODU with HW revision D or lower refer to “Section 2.3.3.2, “Adapting  
2.3.3.1  
Connecting to BreezeMAX PRO-S ODU  
1
The rubber sealing cap (supplied with the SU-ODU) has a special groove  
allowing to insert an ethernet cable with an already assembled RJ-45  
connector through the cap. To expose the groove, lightly squeeze the cap (see  
Figure 2-8). Carefully insert the end of the 55 cm category 5E Ethernet cable  
without the service box through the groove.  
22  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Installation  
groove  
Figure 2-8: Sealing Cap  
2
Expose the RJ-45 connector under the sealing cap on the Ethernet cable and  
connect to the SU-ODU RJ-45 connector (Figure 2-9).  
Figure 2-9: Connecting the SU-ODU connector and inserting the Sealing Cap  
3
Put the sealing cap back in its place. Make sure that the small protrusion on  
the side of the cap fits inside the hole on the connector's protective body.  
4
5
Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable to the SU port on the Wi² unit.  
Verify that the O-ring supplied with the service box kit is in place, attach the  
service box to the unit and tighten the top nut.  
6
Use appropriate sealing material to protect the connection to the SU-ODU  
against moisture and humidity. Use removable sealing material to enable  
future access to the connector.  
NOTE  
Use high quality sealing material such as Scotch® 130C Linerless Rubber Splicing Tape from 3M to  
ensure IP-67 compliant protection against dust and water.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.3.3.2  
Adapting the Ethernet Cable for Connecting to  
BreezeACCESS SU-ODU  
The 55 cm Ethernet cable supplied with the unit has crossed Ethernet  
connections which have to be adapted for connecting the unit to a BreezeACCESS  
ODU:  
1
Cut the cable as close as possible to the connector that should be connected to  
the ODU (the end without the service box).  
2
Use a crimp tool for RJ-45 connectors to prepare the wires. Insert them into  
the appropriate pins of the spare RJ-45 connector supplied with the unit and  
use the tool to crimp the connector. Make sure to do the following:  
Remove as small a length as possible of the external jacket. Verify that the  
external jacket is well inside the sealing cover when connected to the unit,  
to ensure good sealing.  
Pull back the shield drain wire before inserting the cable into the RJ-45  
connector, to ensure a good connection with the connector's shield after  
crimping.  
The cable should provide straight pin-to-pin connections on both ends.  
Figure 2-10 shows the required wire pair connections:  
Figure 2-10: Ethernet Connector Pin Assignments  
The color codes used in the standard cable supplied by with the unit are listed in  
24  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Installation  
Table 2-3: Cable Color Codes  
Wire color  
Blue  
Pin  
1
Blue/white  
Orange  
2
3
Orange/white  
Brown  
6
4
5
7
8
Brown/white  
Green  
Green/white  
2.3.3.3  
2.3.3.4  
Connecting to BreezeACCESS ODU with HW Revision E  
1
Adapt the cable as described in Section 2.3.3.2  
2
Connect the cable to the ODU as described in Section 2.3.3.1.  
Connecting to BreezeACCESS ODU with HW Revision D or  
Lower  
1
Cut the cable as close as possible to the connector that should be connected to  
the ODU (the end without the service box).  
2
3
Route the cable through the service box supplied with the SU-ODU.  
Connect the spare RJ-45 connector, supplied with the cable kit, as described  
in step 2 of Section 2.3.3.2  
4
5
Connect the Ethernet cable to the SU-ODU RJ-45 connector.  
Make sure that the external jacket of the cable is well inside the service box to  
guarantee a good seal.  
6
Verify that the O-ring of the service box kit is in place, attach the service box to  
the unit and tighten the top nut.  
7
8
Connect the other end of the cable to the SU port on the Wi² unit.  
Make sure that the external jacket of the cable is well inside the service box to  
guarantee a good seal. Verify that the O-ring supplied with the service box is in  
place, attach the service box to the unit and tighten the top nut.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.3.4 Preparing the Power Cable  
CAUTION  
Electric Shock Hazard. Only a licensed electrician should connect the power plug.  
All mains used outdoors, in damp or wet conditions, should be supplied from a correctly fused  
source and protected according to applicable local regulations.  
To prepare the power cable:  
1
Use a UL/CSA listed smooth circular power cable, 1.5mm to 2.5mm each.  
Outer diameter 7mm to 9mm, UV resistant, temperature range -40°C to +  
65°C (-40°F to +149°F) minimum. Other specifications (such as oil resistance,  
no of wires) according to specific installation requirements.  
2
3
Use a cap assembly tool to unscrew the locking ring.  
Thread the cable through component parts as shown in Figure 2-11.  
NOTE  
Figure 2-11 shows an AC power jack. The DC power jack is similar, but has only two sockets.  
26  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Installation  
Figure 2-11: Preparing the Power Cable  
4
5
Strip insulation from wires as shown in Figure 2-11.  
Insert bare wire ends into the terminals and fully tighten the screws. The wires  
should be connected as shown below:  
AC  
Phase ~  
DC  
Brown  
Red  
+
Blue  
Neutral 0  
Black  
-
Yellow/green  
Grounding  
6
7
Draw cable back until socket insert is correctly seated in D-shaped location in  
the main body. Tighten the Gland nut. Screw back the locking ring using the  
cap assembly tool.  
For an AC cable, connect a mains plug to the other end of the cable. For a DC  
cable, connect the appropriate termination.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
2.3.5 Mounting the Wi² Unit  
To pole mount the Wi² unit:  
1
2
With the bottom panel of the unit facing downwards, thread the two 9/16"  
wide metal bands supplied through the brackets on the sides of the unit.  
Rotate the mounting bracket, so that the Wi² faces the Base Station.  
NOTE  
The mounting bracket can be rotated up to 45 in any direction.  
o
3
Secure the Wi² unit to a pole as shown in Figure 2-12.  
Figure 2-12: Pole Mounting the Wi²  
2.3.5.1  
Mounting the Wi² Using the Tilt Accessory  
The Wi² can also be installed on a wall or on a non-vertical pole using an optional  
tilt accessory kit. The tilt accessory kit (Figure 2-13) includes:  
A mounting bracket  
3 metal bands for attaching the bracket to a pole  
Screws for attaching the bracket to a wall  
28  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Installation  
A 50 cm pole (diameter 6.03 cm)  
Screws for attaching the pole to mounting bracket  
Figure 2-13: Tilt Accessory Kit  
To mount the tilt accessory on a wall:  
1
2
Place the bracket on the wall and use as a template to mark the position of the  
holes to be drilled for the screws .  
Remove the bracket from the wall and drill a hole in each of the locations  
marked.  
3
4
Insert anchors into the holes.  
Hold the bracket over the holes and insert a screw into each of the holes in the  
bracket, and screw into the anchors in the wall. Secure the bracket to the wall,  
making sure that the screw heads are as level with the bracket as possible.  
To mount the tilt accessory on a non-vertical pole:  
Thread the metal bands provides with the tilt accessory through the slits in  
the bracket and attach to the pole as shown in Figure 2-14.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
Figure 2-14: Mounting Tilt Accessory on Non-Vertical Pole  
To mount the Wi² using the tilt accessory:  
1
2
3
Mount the tilt accessory bracket on the wall or pole as described above.  
Using the screws provided attach the pole to the tilt accessory bracket.  
Using a spirit level, adjust the angle of the pole until it is vertical and tighten  
the screws to hold in place.  
4
Secure the Wi² to the pole as described in “Mounting the Wi² Unit” on page 28.  
Figure 2-15: Wi² Mounting Using the Tilt Accessory  
30  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation  
2.3.6 Connecting the Antenna(s)  
To connect an external antenna:  
1
Connect the external antenna directly to the N-type connector on the top panel  
of the Wi² unit.  
NOTE  
When connecting only one antenna, connect it to the right antenna connector. (When looking at the  
unit from the side of the SU-ODU with the antenna connectors facing upwards, this is the  
connector on the right.)  
2
Set the antenna options for corresponding antenna through the user interface  
CAUTION  
If using antennas other than the Omni 8, make sure you do not exceed local radio regulations.  
2.3.7 Connecting the Grounding Cables  
To connect the grounding cables:  
1
2
3
Connect a grounding cable to the grounding stud on theWi² unit and tighten  
the grounding screw firmly.  
Connect a grounding cable to the grounding stud on the SU-ODU and tighten  
the grounding screw firmly.  
Connect the other ends of the grounding cables to a good ground (earth)  
connection.  
CAUTION  
Be sure that grounding is available and that it meets local and national electrical codes. For  
additional lightning protection, use lightning rods, lightning arrestors, or surge suppressors.  
2.3.8 Connecting to Power Source  
1
Connect the power cable (see Section 2.3.4) to the power socket on the unit  
and to the mains supply.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 2 - Hardware Installation  
CAUTION  
The Wi² can be connected to either an AC or DC power source, or to both. By default the DC plug is  
covered with a waterproof sealing cap which must be removed before connecting to the power  
cable. Any socket that is NOT in use must always be protected from moisture and must be covered  
with a waterproof sealing cap.  
2
Check that the LED on the Wi² is green indicating that the system is working  
normally.  
2.3.9 Configuration and Testing  
2.3.9.1  
Configuring the SU-ODU  
1
2
3
4
5
Disconnect the cable connecting the WiFi Access Point (AP) from the AP  
connector on the Power Supply and Interface module.  
Connect a PC to the AP connector using the 3 m configuration cable (straight)  
supplied with the unit.  
Verify that the SU-ODU is connected to the SU connector on the Power Supply  
and Interface module.  
Using Telnet, connect to the SU-ODU and configure its parameters. For  
configuration details refer to the relevant manual.  
Verify that the SU-ODU is operating properly and that it connects to the base  
station. For details on verifying proper operation and connectivity refer to the  
relevant manual.  
2.3.9.2  
Configuring the Wi²  
1
Disconnect the configuration cable from the unit and reconnect the cable  
between the WiFi Access Point (AP) and the AP connector of the Power Supply  
and Interface module.  
2
3
Disconnect the cable connected to the SU connector on the Power Supply and  
Interface module.  
Connect a PC to the SU connector using the 3 m configuration cable.  
NOTE  
Alternatively, instead of disconnecting the SU connector, you can connect a PC to the Console port  
of the AP with a console cable (ordered separately) and complete all the configuration using CLI.  
4
Using Telnet, log in, and set the country code (available only via CLI) and the  
AP IP address as outlined in Chapter 3 - "Initial Configuration".  
32  
Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation  
5
Complete the configuration of the AP, using either CLI as outlined in Chapter  
5 - "Command Line Interface" or the web-based interface as outlined in  
NOTE  
At least one VAP must be enabled and Antenna ID must be configured to enable transmissions.  
6
7
Disconnect the configuration cable from the Wi² unit and reconnect the cable  
between the SU-ODU and the SU connector of the Power Supply and Interface  
module.  
Using the WiFi client (802.11b/g), locate the Wi² and verify complete  
connectivity to the backbone network.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 - Initial Configuration  
3.1  
Introduction  
The Access Point (AP) unit offers a variety of management options, including a  
web-based interface, Telnet, SSH, SNMP and a direct connection to the console  
port.  
The initial configuration steps can be made through the web browser interface or  
CLI.  
36  
Commissioning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Initial Setup through the CLI  
3.2  
Initial Setup through the CLI  
For a description of how to use the CLI, see “Using the Command Line Interface”  
on page 129. For a list of all the CLI commands and detailed information on using  
the CLI, refer to “Command Groups” on page 136.  
3.2.1 Configuration via Telnet  
By default, use the Telnet option to configure the unit. The AP uses the default  
address 192.168.1.1. This address may not be compatible with your network. You  
will therefore have to use the command line interface (CLI) to assign an IP address  
that is compatible with your network as described on page 38.  
Use the category 5 Ethernet data cable (2 pairs, straight) provided to connect the  
SU port on the Wi² unit to your PC and Telnet the unit to start the initial setup.  
3.2.2 Configuration via Console  
The Wi² has a console port that enables a connection to a PC or terminal for  
monitoring and configuration. Attach a VT100-compatible terminal, or a PC  
running a terminal emulation program to the Wi² using an RS232 console cable.  
To connect to the console port:  
1
Connect the console cable to the serial port on a terminal, or a PC running  
terminal emulation software.  
2
3
Connect the other end of the cable to the console port on the Wi² unit.  
Make sure the terminal emulation software is set as follows:-:  
Select the appropriate serial port (COM port 1 or 2).  
Set the data rate to 9600 baud.  
Set the data format to 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, and no parity.  
Set flow control to none.  
Set the emulation mode to VT100.  
When using HyperTerminal, select Terminal keys, not Windows keys.  
4
Once you have set up the terminal correctly, press the [Enter] key to initiate  
the console connection. The console login screen is displayed.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3 - Initial Configuration  
3.2.3 Initial Configuration Steps  
Logging In – Enter admin for the user name. The default password is null, so just  
press [Enter] at the password prompt. The CLI prompt appears displaying  
Enterprise AP#.  
Username: admin  
Password:  
Enterprise AP#  
Setting the Country Code – You must use the CLI to set the country code.  
Setting the country code restricts operation of the AP to the radio channels and  
transmit power levels permitted for wireless networks in the specified country.  
Type exit to leave configuration mode. Then type country? to display the list of  
countries. Select the code for your country, and enter the country command  
again, following by your country code (e.g., tw for Taiwan).  
Enterprise AP#country tw  
Enterprise AP#  
Setting the IP Address – By default, the AP is configured to obtain IP address  
settings from a DHCP server. If a DHCP server is not available, the IP address  
defaults to 192.168.1.1, which may not be compatible with your network. You will  
therefore have to use the command line interface (CLI) to assign an IP address  
that is compatible with your network.  
Type configure to enter configuration mode, then type interface ethernet to  
access the Ethernet interface-configuration mode.  
Enterprise AP#configure  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enterprise AP(config-if)#  
First type no ip dhcp to disable DHCP client mode. Then type ip address and the  
ip-address netmask gateway, where ip-address is the AP’s IP address, netmask is  
the network mask for the network, and gateway is the default gateway router.  
Check with your system administrator to obtain an IP address that is compatible  
with your network.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#no ip dhcp  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 192.168.2.254  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
38  
Commissioning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Initial Setup through the CLI  
After configuring the AP’s IP parameters, you can access the management  
interface from anywhere within the attached network. The command line interface  
can also be accessed using Telnet from any computer attached to the network.  
NOTE  
Command examples shown later in this manual use the console prompt to Enterprise AP.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 - Initial Configuration  
3.3  
Logging In  
There are a few basic steps you need to complete to connect the AP to your  
corporate network, and provide network access to wireless clients.  
The AP can be managed by any computer using a web browser (Internet Explorer  
5.0 or above, or Netscape 6.2 or above).  
To Log in:  
1
Enter the default IP address http://192.168.1.1. Figure 3-1 is displayed.  
Figure 3-1: Login  
2
3
4
Enter the username admin.  
The password is null, so leave blank and click LOGIN.  
The home page (Figure 3-2) is displayed.  
40  
Commissioning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Logging In  
Figure 3-2: Home Page  
NOTE  
For information on configuring a user name and password, see page 68.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.1  
Introduction  
Before continuing with advanced configuration, first complete the initial  
configuration steps described in Chapter 3 to set up an IP address for the Access  
Point (AP) unit.  
The AP unit can be managed by any computer using a web browser (Internet  
Explorer 5.0 or above, or Netscape 6.2 or above). Enter the configured IP address  
of the AP unit, or use the default address: http://192.168.1.1.  
Enter the default user name admin in the Log In Dialog Box (Figure 3-1) and click  
LOGIN. Select Advanced Setup from the menu on the home page. Figure 4-1 is  
displayed.  
Figure 4-1: Advanced Setup  
The information in this chapter is organized to reflect the structure of the web  
screens for easy reference. However, it is recommended that you configure a user  
name and password as the first step under Administration to control management  
access to this device (Section 4.4.10).  
44  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
BreezeMAX Backhauling Configuration  
4.2  
BreezeMAX Backhauling Configuration  
Note the following when using BreezeMAX for backhauling:  
1
If VLANs are used by the AP (VLAN Classification enabled):  
Maximum number of VLAN IDs behind the SU is 16  
The recommended configuration of BreezeMAX services is:  
¾ Transparent service  
¾ VLAN list is empty or specific VLANs in list (Hybrid Mode is Off)  
¾ No Access VLAN  
2
If VLANs are not used by the AP (VLAN Classification disabled), the  
recommended configuration for BreezeMAX services is:  
Transparent service  
Access VLAN may be used  
VLAN List is empty or Hybrid Mode On.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.3  
BreezeACCESS Backhauling  
Configuration  
Note the following when using BreezeACCESS for backhauling:  
1
If VLANs are used by the AP (VLAN Classification enabled):  
In the SU Access Link should not be used.  
The AU can operate in either Hybrid or Trunk Link (Q in Q should not be  
used)  
2
If VLANs are not used by the AP (VLAN Classification disabled):  
AU and SU should operate in Hybrid Link  
No Management VLAN  
No Data VLAN  
46  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Advanced Configuration  
4.4  
Advanced Configuration  
The Advanced Configuration pages include the following options.  
Table 4-1: Menu  
Menu  
Description  
Page  
System  
Configures basic administrative and client access  
Specifies the host name  
Identification  
TCP / IP Settings  
RADIUS  
Configures the IP address, subnet mask, gateway, and domain name servers  
Configures the RADIUS server for wireless client authentication and accounting  
Configures Secure Shell management access  
SSH Settings  
Authentication  
Configures 802.1X client authentication, with an option for MAC address  
authentication  
Filter Control  
Filters communications between wireless clients, access to the management  
interface from wireless clients, and traffic matching specific Ethernet protocol  
types  
VLAN  
Enables VLAN support and sets the management VLAN ID  
Not applicable for current release  
WDS Settings  
AP Management  
Administration  
Configures access to management interfaces  
Configures user name and password for management access; upgrades software 68  
from local file, FTP or TFTP server; resets configuration settings to factory  
defaults; and resets the AP  
System Log  
Controls logging of error messages; sets the system clock via SNTP server or  
manual configuration  
RSSI  
Not applicable for current release  
Configures SNMP settings  
SNMP  
Radio Interface G  
Radio Settings  
Configures the IEEE 802.11g interface  
Configures common radio signal parameters and other settings for each VAP  
interface  
Security  
Status  
Enables each VAP interface, sets the SSID, and configures wireless security  
Displays information about the access point and wireless clients  
Displays configuration settings for the basic system and the wireless interface  
Shows the wireless clients currently associated with the access point  
Shows log messages stored in memory  
AP Status  
Station Status  
Event Logs  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
NOTE  
This chapter may include references to features that are not applicable to the current release such as  
Radio A, WDS Settings and RSSI.  
4.4.1 System Identification  
The system name can be left with the default setting. However, modifying this  
parameter enables you to easily identify different devices in your network.  
Figure 4-2: Identification  
System Name – An alias for the AP, enabling the device to be uniquely identified  
on the network. (Default: BlueSecure BSAP-1600; Range: 1-32 characters)  
48  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Advanced Configuration  
4.4.1.0.1  
CLI Commands for System Identification  
Enter the global configuration mode, and use the system name command to  
specify a new system name. Return to the Exec mode, and use the show system  
command to display the changes to the system identification settings.  
Enterprise AP#config  
Enter configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(config)#system name R&D  
Enterprise AP(config)#end  
Enterprise AP#show system  
System Information  
==============================================================  
Serial Number  
: 0000000000  
System Up time  
: 2 days, 4 hours, 33 minutes, 38 seconds  
System Name  
: R&D  
System Location  
System Contact  
System Country Code  
System Country Code  
:
: Contact  
Radio G MAC Address : 00-12-CF-12-34-95  
IP Address  
: 192.168.1.2  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 192.168.1.254  
: DISABLED  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
VLAN State  
Management VLAN ID(AP): 1  
IAPP State  
: ENABLED  
DHCP Client  
HTTP Server  
HTTP Server Port  
: DISABLED  
: ENABLED  
: 80  
HTTP Session Timeout : 300 sec(s)  
HTTPS Server  
HTTPS Server Port  
Slot Status  
Boot Rom Version  
Software Version  
SSH Server  
SSH Server Port  
Telnet Server  
DHCP Relay  
: ENABLED  
: 443  
: 802.11g only  
: v2.1.6  
: v4.3.3.8b02  
: ENABLED  
: 22  
: ENABLED  
: DISABLED  
==============================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.4.2 TCP / IP Settings  
Configuring the AP with an IP address expands your ability to manage the AP. A  
number of features depend on IP addressing to operate.  
NOTE  
You can use the web browser interface to access IP addressing only if the AP already has an IP  
address that is accessible through your network.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
By default, the AP is automatically configured with IP settings from a Dynamic  
Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server. However, if you are not using a DHCP  
server to configure IP addressing, use the CLI to manually configure the initial IP  
values (see page 38). Once you have network access to the AP, you can use the  
web browser interface to modify the initial IP configuration, if necessary.  
NOTE  
If there is no DHCP server on your network, or DHCP fails, the AP will automatically start up with a  
default IP address of 192.168.1.1.  
Figure 4-3: TCP/IP Settings  
DHCP Client (Enable) – Select this option to obtain the IP settings for the AP from a  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server. The IP address, subnet  
mask, default gateway, and Domain Name Server (DNS) address are dynamically  
assigned to the AP by the network DHCP server. (Default: Enabled)  
DHCP Client (Disable) – Select this option to manually configure a static address  
for the AP.  
IP Address: The IP address of the AP. Valid IP addresses consist of four  
decimal numbers, 0 to 255, separated by periods.  
Subnet Mask: The mask that identifies the host address bits used for routing  
to specific subnets.  
50  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Advanced Configuration  
Default Gateway: The default gateway is the IP address of the router for the  
AP, which is used if the requested destination address is not on the local  
subnet.  
If you have management stations, DNS, RADIUS, or other network servers  
located on another subnet, type the IP address of the default gateway router in  
the text field provided. Otherwise, leave the address as all zeros (0.0.0.0).  
Primary and Secondary DNS Address: The IP address of Domain Name Servers  
on the network. A DNS maps numerical IP addresses to domain names and  
can be used to identify network hosts by familiar names instead of the IP  
addresses.  
If you have one or more DNS servers located on the local network, type the IP  
addresses in the text fields provided. Otherwise, leave the addresses as all  
zeros (0.0.0.0).  
4.4.2.0.1  
CLI Commands for TCP/IP Settings  
From the global configuration mode, enter the interface configuration mode with  
the interface ethernet command. Use the ip dhcp command to enable the DHCP  
client, or no ip dhcp to disable it. To manually configure an address, specify the  
new IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway using the ip address  
command. To specify DNS server addresses use the dns server command and use  
the show interface ethernet command from the Exec mode to display the  
current IP settings.  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enter Ethernet configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#no ip dhcp  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip address 192.168.1.2  
255.255.255.0 192.168.1.253  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#dns primary-server 192.168.1.55  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#dns secondary-server 10.1.0.55  
Enterprise AP(config)#end  
Enterprise AP#show interface ethernet  
Ethernet Interface Information  
========================================  
IP Address  
: 192.168.1.2  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 192.168.1.253  
: 192.168.1.55  
: 10.1.0.55  
: Up  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
Primary DNS  
Secondary DNS  
Admin status  
Operational status : Up  
========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.4.3 RADIUS  
Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) is an authentication  
protocol that uses software running on a central server to control access to  
RADIUS-aware devices on the network. An authentication server contains a  
database of user credentials for each user that requires access to the network.  
A primary RADIUS server must be specified for the AP to implement IEEE 802.1X  
network access control and WiFi Protected Access (WPA) wireless security. A  
secondary RADIUS server may also be specified as a backup should the primary  
server fail or become inaccessible.  
In addition, the configured RADIUS server can also act as a RADIUS Accounting  
server and receive user-session accounting information from the AP. RADIUS  
Accounting can be used to provide valuable information on user activity in the  
network.  
NOTE  
This manual assumes that you have already configured RADIUS server(s) to support the AP.  
Configuration of RADIUS server software is beyond the scope of this manul, refer to the  
documentation provided with the RADIUS server software.  
52  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Advanced Configuration  
Figure 4-4: RADIUS  
MAC Address Format – MAC addresses can be specified in one of four formats,  
using no delimiter, with a single dash delimiter, with multiple dash delimiters,  
and with multiple colon delimiters.  
VLAN ID Format – A VLAN ID (a number between 1 and 4094) can be assigned to  
each client after successful authentication using IEEE 802.1X and a central  
RADIUS server. The user VLAN IDs must be configured on the RADIUS server for  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
each user authorized to access the network. VLAN IDs can be entered as  
hexadecimal numbers or as ASCII strings.  
Primary Radius Server Setup – Configure the following settings to use RADIUS  
authentication on the AP.  
Radius Status: Enabling Radius Status allows the settings of RADIUS  
authentication. (Default: Enable)  
IP Address: Specifies the IP address or host name of the RADIUS server.  
Port: The UDP port number used by the RADIUS server for authentication  
messages. (Range: 1024-65535; Default: 1812)  
Key: A shared text string used to encrypt messages between the AP and the  
RADIUS server. Be sure that the same text string is specified on the RADIUS  
server. Do not use blank spaces in the string. (Maximum length: 255  
characters)  
Timeout: Number of seconds the AP waits for a reply from the RADIUS server  
before resending a request. (Range: 1-60 seconds; Default: 5)  
Retransmit attempts: The number of times the AP tries to resend a request to  
the RADIUS server before authentication fails. (Range: 1-30; Default: 3)  
Accounting Port: The RADIUS Accounting server UDP port used for accounting  
messages. (Range: 0 or 1024-65535; Default: 0, disabled)  
Interim Update Timeout: The interval between transmitting accounting updates  
to the RADIUS server. (Range: 60-86400; Default: 3600 seconds)  
NOTE  
For the Timeout and Retransmit attempts fields, accept the default values unless you experience  
problems connecting to the RADIUS server over the network.  
Secondary Radius Server Setup – Configure a secondary RADIUS server to provide  
a backup in case the primary server fails. The AP uses the secondary server if the  
primary server fails or becomes inaccessible. Once the AP switches over to the  
secondary server, it periodically attempts to establish communication again with  
primary server. If communication with the primary server is re-established, the  
secondary server reverts to a backup role.  
54  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Configuration  
4.4.3.0.1  
CLI Commands for RADIUS  
From the global configuration mode, use the radius-server address command to  
specify the address of the primary or secondary RADIUS servers. (The following  
example configures the settings for the primary RADIUS server.) Configure the  
other parameters for the RADIUS server. Then use the show radius command  
from the Exec mode to display the current settings for the primary and secondary  
RADIUS servers.  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server address 192.168.1.25  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server port 181  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server key green  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server timeout 10  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server retransmit 5  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server port-accounting 1813  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server timeout-interim 500  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show radius  
Radius Server Information  
========================================  
IP  
Port  
: 192.168.1.25  
: 181  
Key  
Retransmit  
Timeout  
: *****  
: 5  
: 10  
Radius MAC format : no-delimiter  
Radius VLAN format : HEX  
========================================  
Radius Secondary Server Information  
========================================  
IP  
Port  
Key  
Retransmit  
Timeout  
: 0.0.0.0  
: 1812  
: *****  
: 3  
: 5  
Radius MAC format : no-delimiter  
Radius VLAN format : HEX  
========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.4.4 SSH Settings  
Telnet is a remote management tool that can be used to configure the AP from  
anywhere in the network. However, Telnet is not secure from hostile attacks. The  
Secure Shell (SSH) can act as a secure replacement for Telnet. The SSH protocol  
uses generated public keys to encrypt all data transfers passing between the AP  
and SSH-enabled management station clients and ensures that data traveling  
over the network arrives unaltered. Clients can then securely use the local user  
name and password for access authentication.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
SSH client software needs to be installed on the management station to access the  
AP for management via the SSH protocol.  
NOTE  
The AP supports only SSH version 2.0.  
After boot up, the SSH server needs about two minutes to generate host encryption keys. The  
SSH server is disabled while the keys are being generated.  
Figure 4-5: SSH Settings  
4.4.4.1  
SSH Settings  
Telnet Server Status – Enables or disables the Telnet server. (Default: Enabled)  
SSH Server Status – Enables or disables the SSH server. (Default: Enabled)  
SSH Server Port – Sets the UDP port for the SSH server. (Range: 1-65535;  
Default: 22)  
4.4.4.1.1  
CLI Commands for SSH  
To enable the SSH server, use the ip ssh-server enable command from the CLI  
Ethernet interface configuration mode. To set the SSH server UDP port, use the ip  
ssh-server port command. To view the current settings, use the show system  
command from the CLI Exec mode (not shown in the following example).  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#no ip telnet-server  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip ssh-server enable  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip ssh-server port 1124  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#exit  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
56  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Advanced Configuration  
4.4.5 Authentication  
Wireless clients can be authenticated for network access by checking their MAC  
address against the local database configured on the AP, or by using a database  
configured on a central RADIUS server. Alternatively, authentication can be  
implemented using the IEEE 802.1X network access control protocol.  
A client’s MAC address provides relatively weak user authentication, since MAC  
addresses can be easily captured and used by another station to break into the  
network. Using 802.1X provides more robust user authentication using user  
names and passwords or digital certificates. You can configure the access point to  
use both MAC address and 802.1X authentication, with client station MAC  
authentication occurring prior to IEEE 802.1X authentication. However, it is  
better to choose one or the other, as appropriate.  
Take note of the following points before configuring MAC address or 802.1X  
authentication:  
Use MAC address authentication for a small network with a limited number of  
users. MAC addresses can be manually configured on the AP itself without the  
need to set up a RADIUS server, but managing a large number of MAC  
addresses across many APs is very cumbersome. A RADIUS server can be used  
to centrally manage a larger database of user MAC addresses.  
Use IEEE 802.1X authentication for networks with a larger number of users  
and where security is the most important issue. When using 802.1X  
authentication, a RADIUS server is required in the wired network to centrally  
manage the credentials of the wireless clients. It also provides a mechanism  
for enhanced network security using dynamic encryption key rotation or WiFi  
Protected Access (WPA).  
NOTE  
If you configure RADIUS MAC authentication together with 802.1X, RADIUS MAC address  
authentication is performed prior to 802.1X authentication. If RADIUS MAC authentication  
succeeds, then 802.1X authentication is performed. If RADIUS MAC authentication fails, 802.1X  
authentication is not performed.  
The AP can also operate in a 802.1X supplicant mode. This enables the AP  
itself to be authenticated with a RADIUS server using a configured MD5 user  
name and password. This prevents rogue APs from gaining access to the  
network.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Figure 4-6: Authentication  
MAC Authentication – You can configure a list of the MAC addresses for wireless  
clients that are authorized to access the network. This provides a basic level of  
authentication for wireless clients attempting to gain access to the network. A  
database of authorized MAC addresses can be stored locally on the AP or remotely  
on a central RADIUS server. (Default: Disabled)  
Disabled: No checks are performed on an associating station’s MAC address.  
Local MAC: The MAC address of the associating station is compared against  
the local database stored on the AP. Use the Local MAC Authentication section  
of this web page to set up the local database, and configure all APs in the  
wireless network service area with the same MAC address database.  
Radius MAC: The MAC address of the associating station is sent to a  
configured RADIUS server for authentication. When using a RADIUS  
authentication server for MAC address authentication, the server must first be  
configured in the Radius window (see “RADIUS” on page 52). The database of  
MAC addresses and filtering policy must be defined in the RADIUS server.  
58  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Advanced Configuration  
NOTE  
MAC addresses on the RADIUS server can be entered in four different formats (see “RADIUS”  
802.1X Supplicant – The AP can also operate in a 802.1X supplicant mode. This  
enables the access point itself to be authenticated with a RADIUS server using a  
configured MD5 user name and password. This prevents rogue APs from gaining  
access to the network.  
Local MAC Authentication – Configures the local MAC authentication database.  
The MAC database provides a mechanism to take certain actions based on a  
wireless client’s MAC address. The MAC list can be configured to allow or deny  
network access to specific clients.  
System Default: Specifies a default action for all unknown MAC addresses  
(that is, those not listed in the local MAC database).  
Deny: Blocks access for all MAC addresses except those listed in the local  
database as “Allow.”  
Allow: Permits access for all MAC addresses except those listed in the local  
database as “Deny.”  
MAC Authentication Settings: Enters specified MAC addresses and permissions  
into the local MAC database.  
MAC Address: Physical address of a client. Enter six pairs of hexadecimal  
digits separated by hyphens; for example, 00-90-D1-12-AB-89.  
Permission: Select Allow to permit access or Deny to block access. If Delete  
is selected, the specified MAC address entry is removed from the database.  
Update: Enters the specified MAC address and permission setting into the  
local database.  
MAC Authentication Table: Displays current entries in the local MAC database.  
4.4.5.0.1  
CLI Commands for Local MAC Authentication  
Use the mac-authentication server command from the global configuration  
mode to enable local MAC authentication. Use the mac-authentication  
session-timeout command to set the authentication interval to enable web-based  
authentication for service billing. Set the default action for MAC addresses not in  
the local table using the address filter default command, then enter MAC  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
addresses in the local table using the address filter entry command. To remove  
an entry from the table, use the address filter delete command. To display the  
current settings, use the show authentication command from the Exec mode.  
Enterprise AP(config)#mac-authentication server local  
Enterprise AP(config)#mac-authentication session-timeout 5  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter default denied  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter entry  
00-70-50-cc-99-1a denied  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter entry  
00-70-50-cc-99-1b allowed  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter entry  
00-70-50-cc-99-1c allowed  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter delete  
00-70-50-cc-99-1c  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show authentication  
Authentication Information  
===========================================================  
MAC Authentication Server  
: LOCAL  
MAC Auth Session Timeout Value : 0 min  
802.1x supplicant  
: DISABLED  
802.1x supplicant user  
802.1x supplicant password  
Address Filtering  
: EMPTY  
: EMPTY  
: DENIED  
System Default : ALLOW addresses not found in filter table.  
Filter Table  
MAC Address  
Status  
-----------------  
00-70-50-cc-99-1a  
00-70-50-cc-99-1b  
----------  
DENIED  
ALLOWED  
=========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.4.5.0.2  
CLI Commands for RADIUS MAC Authentication  
Use the mac-authentication server command from the global configuration  
mode to enable remote MAC authentication. Set the timeout value for  
re-authentication using the mac- authentication session-timeout command. Be  
sure to also configure connection settings for the RADIUS server (not shown in the  
following example). To display the current settings, use the show authentication  
command from the Exec mode.  
60  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Configuration  
Enterprise AP(config)#mac-authentication server remote  
Enterprise AP(config)#mac-authentication  
session-timeout 300  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show authentication  
Authentication Information  
===========================================================  
MAC Authentication Server  
: REMOTE  
MAC Auth Session Timeout Value : 300 min  
802.1x supplicant  
: DISABLED  
: EMPTY  
: EMPTY  
802.1x supplicant user  
802.1x supplicant password  
Address Filtering  
: DENIED  
System Default : DENY addresses not found in filter table.  
Filter Table  
MAC Address  
Status  
-----------------  
00-70-50-cc-99-1a  
00-70-50-cc-99-1b  
----------  
DENIED  
ALLOWED  
=========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.4.5.0.3  
CLI Command for 802.1x Supplicant  
To configure the AP to operate as a 802.1X supplicant, first use the 802.1X  
supplicant user command to set a user name and password for the AP, then use  
the 802.1X supplicant command to enable the feature. To display the current  
settings, use the show authentication command from the Exec mode (not shown  
in the following example)  
Enterprise AP(config)#802.1X supplicant user secureAP dot1xpass  
Enterprise AP(config)#802.1X supplicant  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
4.4.6 Filter Control  
The AP can employ network traffic frame filtering to control access to network  
resources and increase security. You can prevent communications between  
wireless clients and prevent AP management from wireless clients. You can also  
block specific Ethernet traffic from being forwarded by the AP.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Figure 4-7: Filter Control  
Inter Client STAs Communication Filter – Sets the global mode for  
wireless-to-wireless communications between clients associated to Virtual AP  
(VAP) interfaces on the AP. (Default: Disabled)  
Disabled: All clients can communicate with each other through the access  
point.  
Prevent Intra VAP client communication: When enabled, clients associated with  
a specific VAP interface cannot establish wireless communications with each  
other. Clients can communicate with clients associated to other VAP  
interfaces.  
Prevent Inter and Intra VAP client communication: When enabled, clients cannot  
establish wireless communications with any other client, either those  
associated to the same VAP interface or any other VAP interface.  
AP Management Filter – Controls management access to the AP from wireless  
clients. Management interfaces include the web, Telnet, or SNMP.  
(Default: Enabled)  
62  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Advanced Configuration  
Disabled: Allows management access from wireless clients.  
Enabled: Blocks management access from wireless clients.  
Uplink Port MAC Address Filtering Status – Prevents traffic with specified source  
MAC addresses from being forwarded to wireless clients through the AP. You can  
add a maximum of four MAC addresses to the filter table. (Default: Disabled)  
MAC Address: Specifies a MAC address to filter, in the form xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx.  
Permission: Adds or deletes a MAC address from the filtering table.  
Ethernet Type Filter – Controls checks on the Ethernet type of all incoming and  
outgoing Ethernet packets against the protocol filtering table. (Default: Disabled)  
Disabled: AP does not filter Ethernet protocol types.  
Enabled: AP filters Ethernet protocol types based on the configuration of  
protocol types in the filter table. If the status of a protocol is set to ON, the  
protocol is filtered from the AP.  
NOTE  
Ethernet protocol types not listed in the filtering table are always forwarded by the AP.  
Ethernet Type Filter – Enables or disables Ethernet filtering on the port. (Default:  
Disabled)  
4.4.6.0.1  
CLI Commands for Bridge Filtering  
Use the filter local-bridge command from the global configuration mode to  
prevent wireless-to-wireless communications through the AP. Use the filter  
ap-manage command to restrict management access from wireless clients. To  
configure Ethernet protocol filtering, use the filter ethernet-type enable  
command to enable filtering and the filter ethernet-type protocol command to  
define the protocols that you want to filter. To remove an entry from the table, use  
the address filter delete command. To display the current settings, use the show  
filters command from the Exec mode.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter local-bridge  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter ap-manage  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter uplink enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter uplink add 00-12-34-56-78-9a  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter ethernet-type enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter ethernet-type protocol ARP  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show filters  
Protocol Filter Information  
=========================================================  
Local Bridge  
AP Management  
:ENABLED  
:ENABLED  
Ethernet Type Filter :ENABLED  
Enabled Protocol Filters  
---------------------------------------------------------  
Protocol: ARP  
ISO: 0x0806  
=========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.4.7 VLAN  
The AP can employ VLAN tagging support to control access to network resources  
and increase security. VLANs separate traffic passing between the AP, associated  
clients, and the wired network. There can be a VLAN assigned to each associated  
client, a default VLAN for each VAP (Virtual Access Point) interface, and a  
management VLAN for the AP.  
Note the following points about the AP’s VLAN support:  
The management VLAN is for managing the AP through remote management  
tools, such as the web interface, SSH, SNMP, or Telnet. The AP only accepts  
management traffic that is tagged with the specified management VLAN ID.  
All wireless clients associated to the AP are assigned to a VLAN. If IEEE  
802.1X is being used to authenticate wireless clients, specific VLAN IDs can be  
configured on the RADIUS server to be assigned to each client. If a client is not  
assigned to a specific VLAN or if 802.1X is not used, the client is assigned to  
the default VLAN for the VAP interface with which it is associated. The AP only  
allows traffic tagged with assigned VLAN IDs or default VLAN IDs to access  
clients associated on each VAP interface.  
When VLAN support is enabled on the AP, traffic passed to the wired network  
is tagged with the appropriate VLAN ID, either an assigned client VLAN ID,  
default VLAN ID, or the management VLAN ID. Traffic received from the wired  
network must also be tagged with one of these known VLAN IDs. Received  
traffic that has an unknown VLAN ID or no VLAN tag is dropped.  
64  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Advanced Configuration  
When VLAN support is disabled, the AP does not tag traffic passed to the wired  
network and ignores the VLAN tags on any received frames.  
NOTE  
Before enabling VLAN tagging on the AP, be sure to configure the backhaul system to support  
tagged VLAN frames from the AP’s management VLAN ID, default VLAN IDs, and other client  
VLAN IDs. Otherwise, connectivity to the AP will be lost when you enable the VLAN feature.  
Using IEEE 802.1X and a central RADIUS server, up to 64 VLAN IDs can be  
mapped to specific wireless clients, allowing users to remain within the same  
VLAN as they move around a campus site. This feature can also be used to control  
access to network resources from clients, thereby improving security.  
A VLAN ID (1-4094) can be assigned to a client after successful IEEE 802.1X  
authentication. The client VLAN IDs must be configured on the RADIUS server for  
each user authorized to access the network. If a client does not have a configured  
VLAN ID on the RADIUS server, the AP assigns the client to the configured default  
VLAN ID for the VAP interface.  
NOTE  
When using IEEE 802.1X to dynamically assign VLAN IDs, the AP must have 802.1X authentication  
enabled and a RADIUS server configured. Wireless clients must also support 802.1X client  
software.  
When setting up VLAN IDs for each user on the RADIUS server, be sure to use the  
RADIUS attributes and values as indicated Table 4-2.  
Table 4-2: RADIUS Attributes  
Number  
RADIUS Attribute  
Tunnel-Type  
Value  
VLAN (13)  
802  
64  
65  
81  
Tunnel-Medium-Type  
Tunnel-Private-Group-ID  
VLANID  
(1 to 4094 as hexadecimal or string)  
VLAN IDs on the RADIUS server can be entered as hexadecimal digits or a string  
NOTE  
The specific configuration of RADIUS server software is beyond the scope of this manual. Refer to  
the documentation provided with the RADIUS server software.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Figure 4-8: VLAN Configuration  
VLAN Classification – Enables or disables VLAN tagging support on the AP.  
Native VLAN ID – The VLAN ID that traffic must have to be able to manage the AP.  
(Range 1-4094; Default: 1)  
4.4.8 WDS Settings  
WDS Settings is not applicable for the current release.  
4.4.9 AP Management  
The Web, Telnet, and SNMP management interfaces are enabled and open to all IP  
addresses by default. To provide more security for management access to the AP,  
specific interfaces can be disabled and management restricted to a single IP  
address or a limited range of IP addresses.  
Once you specify an IP address or range of addresses, access to management  
interfaces is restricted to the specified addresses. If anyone tries to access a  
management interface from an unauthorized address, the AP will reject the  
connection.  
66  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Advanced Configuration  
Figure 4-9: AP Management  
UI Management – Enables or disables management access through Telnet, the  
Web (HTTP), or SNMP interfaces. (Default: Enabled)  
NOTE  
Secure Web (HTTPS) connections are not affected by the UI Management or IP Management  
settings.  
IP Management – Restricts management access to Telnet, Web, and SNMP  
interfaces to specified IP addresses. (Default: Any IP)  
Any IP: Indicates that any IP address is allowed management access.  
Single IP: Specifies a single IP address that is allowed management access.  
Multiple IP: Specifies an address range as defined by the entered IP address  
and subnet mask. For example, IP address 192.168.1.6 and subnet mask  
255.255.255.0, defines all IP addresses from 192.168.1.6 to 192.168.1.254.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.4.9.0.1  
CLI Commands for AP Management features.  
Enterprise AP(config)#apmgmtip multiple 192.168.1.6 255.255.255.0  
Enterprise AP(config)#apmgmtui SNMP enable  
4.4.10 Administration  
4.4.10.1 Changing the Password  
Management access to the web and CLI interface on the AP is controlled through a  
single user name and password. You can also gain additional access security by  
using control filters (see “Filter Control” on page 61).  
To protect access to the management interface, you need to change the default  
user name and password as soon as possible. If the user name and password are  
not changed, anyone having access to the AP can compromise AP and network  
security. Once a new administrator has been configured, you can delete the  
default admin user name from the system.  
Figure 4-10: Administration  
Username – The name of the user. The default name is admin. (Length: 3-16  
characters, case sensitive)  
New Password – The password for management access. (Length: 3-16 characters,  
case sensitive)  
Confirm New Password – Enter the password again for verification.  
4.4.10.1.1 CLI Commands for Changing User Name and Password  
Use the username and password commands from the CLI configuration mode.  
Enterprise AP(config)#username bob  
Enterprise AP(config)#password admin  
Enterprise AP#  
68  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Advanced Configuration  
4.4.10.2 Setting the Timeout Interval  
You can set the timeout interval for web access to the unit, after which the user  
will have to re-enter the username and password.  
Figure 4-11: Session Timeout for WEB  
Session Timeout for WEB: Sets the time limit for an idle web interface session.  
(Range: 0-1800 seconds; Default: 300 seconds; 0 is disabled)  
4.4.10.2.1 CLI Command for the Web Session Timeout  
Use the ip http session-timeout command from the CLI configuration mode.  
Enterprise AP(config)#ip http session-timeout 0  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
4.4.10.3 Upgrading Firmware  
You can upgrade new AP software from a local file on the management  
workstation, or from an FTP or TFTP server. New software may be provided  
periodically from your distributor.  
After upgrading new software, you must reboot the AP to implement the new code.  
Until a reboot occurs, the AP will continue to run the software it was using before  
the upgrade started. Also note that new software that is incompatible with the  
current configuration automatically restores the AP to the factory default settings  
when first activated after a reboot.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Figure 4-12: Firmware Upgrade  
Before upgrading new software, verify that the AP is connected to the network and  
has been configured with a compatible IP address and subnet mask.  
If you need to download from an FTP or TFTP server, take the following additional  
steps:  
Obtain the IP address of the FTP or TFTP server where the AP software is  
stored.  
If upgrading from an FTP server, be sure that you have an account configured  
on the server with a user name and password.  
If VLANs are configured on the AP, determine the VLAN ID with which the FTP  
or TFTP server is associated, and then configure the management station, or  
the network port to which it is attached, with the same VLAN ID. If you are  
70  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Configuration  
managing the AP from a wireless client, the VLAN ID for the wireless client  
must be configured on a RADIUS server.  
Current version – Version number of runtime code.  
Firmware Upgrade Local – Downloads an operation code image file from the web  
management station to the AP using HTTP. Use the Browse button to locate the  
image file locally on the management station and click Start Upgrade to proceed.  
New firmware file: Specifies the name of the code file on the server. The new  
firmware file name should not contain slashes (\ or /), the leading letter of the  
file name should not be a period (.), and the maximum length for file names is  
32 characters for files on the access point. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z, 0-9, “.”,  
“-”, “_”)  
Firmware Upgrade Remote – Downloads an operation code image file from a  
specified remote FTP or TFTP server. After filling in the following fields, click Start  
Upgrade to proceed.  
New firmware file: Specifies the name of the code file on the server. The new  
firmware file name should not contain slashes (\ or /), the leading letter of the  
file name should not be a period (.), and the maximum length for file names on  
the FTP/TFTP server is 255 characters or 32 characters for files on the access  
point. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z, 0-9, “.”, “-”, “_”)  
IP Address: IP address or host name of FTP or TFTP server.  
Username: The user ID used for login on an FTP server.  
Password: The password used for login on an FTP server.  
Configuration File Backup/Restore – Uploads the current AP configuration file to a  
specified remote FTP or TFTP server. A configuration file can also be downloaded  
to the AP to restore a specific configuration.  
Export/Import: Select Export to upload a file to an FTP/TFTP server. Select  
Import to download a file from an FTP/TFTP server.  
Config file: Specifies the name of the configuration file, which must always be  
"syscfg." A path on the server can be specified using “/” in the name, providing  
the path already exists; for example, “myfolder/syscfg.” Other than to indicate  
a path, the file name must not contain any slashes (\ or /), the leading letter  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
cannot be a period (.), and the maximum length for file names on the  
FTP/TFTP server is 255 characters. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z, 0-9, “.”, “-”, “_”)  
IP Address: IP address or host name of FTP or TFTP server.  
Username: The user ID used for login on an FTP server.  
Password: The password used for login on an FTP server.  
Restore Factory Settings – Click the Restore button to reset the configuration  
settings for the AP to the factory defaults and reboot the system. Note that all user  
configured information will be lost. You will have to re-enter the default user name  
(admin) to re-gain management access to this device.  
Reboot Access Point – Click the Reset button to reboot the system.  
NOTE  
If you have upgraded system software, then you must reboot the AP to implement the new  
operation code. New software that is incompatible with the current configuration automatically  
restores the AP to default values when first activated after a reboot.  
Upon uploading a new configuration file you will be prompted to either restore  
factory settings, or reboot the unit.  
Figure 4-13: New Configuration Warning  
72  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Advanced Configuration  
4.4.10.3.1 CLI Commands for Downloading Software from a TFTP Server  
Use the copy tftp file command from the Exec mode and then specify the file  
type, name, and IP address of the TFTP server. When the download is complete,  
the dir command can be used to check that the new file is present in the AP file  
system. To run the new software, use the reset board command to reboot the AP.  
Enterprise AP#copy tftp file  
1. Application image  
2. Config file  
3. Boot block image  
Select the type of download<1,2,3>: [1]:1  
TFTP Source file name:img.bin  
TFTP Server IP:192.168.1.19  
Enterprise AP#dir  
File Name  
Type File Size  
---- -----------  
--------------------------  
dflt-img.bin  
img.bin  
syscfg  
syscfg_bak  
2
2
5
5
1319939  
1629577  
17776  
17776  
262144 byte(s) available  
Enterprise AP#reset board  
Reboot system now? <y/n>: y  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.4.11 System Log  
The AP can be configured to send event and error messages to a System Log  
Server. The system clock can also be synchronized with a time server, so that all  
the messages sent to the Syslog server are stamped with the correct time and  
date.  
Figure 4-14: System Log  
4.4.11.1 Enabling System Logging  
The AP supports a logging process that can control error messages saved to  
memory or sent to a Syslog server. The logged messages serve as a valuable tool  
for isolating AP and network problems.  
System Log Setup – Enables the logging of error messages. (Default: Disable)  
Server (1-4) – Enables the sending of log messages to a Syslog server host. Up to  
four Syslog servers are supported on the AP. (Default: Disable)  
Server Name/IP – The IP address or name of a Syslog server. (Default: 0.0.0.0)  
UDP Port – The UDP port used by a Syslog server. (Range: 514 or 11024-65535;  
Default: 514)  
Logging Console – Enables the logging of error messages to the console.  
(Default: Disable)  
74  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Advanced Configuration  
Logging Level – Sets the minimum severity level for event logging.  
(Default: Informational)  
The system allows you to limit the messages that are logged by specifying a  
minimum severity level. Table 4-3 lists the error message levels from the most  
severe (Emergency) to least severe (Debug). The message levels that are logged  
include the specified minimum level up to the Emergency level.  
Table 4-3: Error Message Levels  
Error Level  
Emergency  
Alerts  
Description  
System unusable  
Immediate action needed  
Critical  
Critical conditions (e.g., memory allocation, or free memory error - resource exhausted)  
Error conditions (e.g., invalid input, default used)  
Warning conditions (e.g., return false, unexpected return)  
Normal but significant condition, such as cold start  
Informational messages only  
Error  
Warning  
Notice  
Informational  
Debug  
Debugging messages  
NOTE  
The AP error log can be viewed using the Event Logs window in the Status section ( page 124).  
The Event Logs window displays the last 128 messages logged in chronological order, from the  
newest to the oldest. Log messages saved in the AP’s memory are erased when the device is  
rebooted.  
Logging Facility Type – Sets the facility type for remote logging of syslog messages.  
The command specifies the facility type tag sent in syslog messages. (See RFC  
3164.) This type has no effect on the kind of messages reported by the switch.  
However, it may be used by the syslog server to sort messages or to store  
messages in the corresponding database. (Range: 16-23; Default: 16)  
4.4.11.1.1 CLI Commands for System Logging  
To enable logging on the AP, use the logging on command from the global  
configuration mode. The logging level command sets the minimum level of  
message to log. Use the logging console command to enable logging to the  
console. Use the logging host command to specify up to four Syslog servers. The  
CLI also allows the logging facility-type command to set the facility-type number  
to use on the Syslog server. To view the current logging settings, use the show  
logging command.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging on  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging level alert  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging console  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging host 1 IP 10.1.0.3 514  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging host 1 Port 514  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging facility-type 19  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show logging  
Logging Information  
============================================  
Syslog State  
Logging Console State  
Logging Level  
Logging Facility Type  
Servers  
: Enabled  
: Enabled  
: Alert  
: 19  
1: 10.1.0.3, UDP Port: 514, State: Enabled  
2: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
3: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
4: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
=============================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.4.11.2 Configuring SNTP  
Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) allows the AP to set its internal clock based  
on periodic updates from a time server (SNTP or NTP). Maintaining an accurate  
time on the AP enables the system log to record meaningful dates and times for  
event entries. If the clock is not set, the AP will only record the time from the  
factory default set at the last bootup.  
The AP acts as an SNTP client, periodically sending time synchronization requests  
to specific time servers. You can configure up to two time server IP addresses. The  
AP will attempt to poll each server in the configured sequence.  
SNTP Server – Configures the AP to operate as an SNTP client. When enabled, at  
least one time server IP address must be specified.  
Primary Server: The IP address of an SNTP or NTP time server that the AP  
attempts to poll for a time update.  
Secondary Server: The IP address of a secondary SNTP or NTP time server. The  
AP first attempts to update the time from the primary server; if this fails it  
attempts an update from the secondary server.  
76  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Advanced Configuration  
NOTE  
The AP also allows you to disable SNTP and set the system clock manually.  
Set Time Zone – SNTP uses Coordinated Universal Time (or UTC, formerly  
Greenwich Mean Time, or GMT) based on the time at the Earth’s prime meridian,  
zero degrees longitude. To display a time corresponding to your local time, you  
must indicate the number of hours your time zone is located before (east) or after  
(west) UTC.  
Enable Daylight Saving – The AP provides a way to automatically adjust the  
system clock for Daylight Savings Time changes. To use this feature you must  
define the month and date to begin and to end the change from standard time.  
During this period the system clock is set back by one hour.  
4.4.11.2.1 CLI Commands for SNTP  
To enable SNTP support on the AP, from the global configuration mode specify  
SNTP server IP addresses using the sntp-server ip command, then use the  
sntp-server enable command to enable the service. Use the sntp-server  
timezone command to set the time zone for your location, and the sntp-server  
daylight-saving command to set daylight savings. To view the current SNTP  
settings, use the show sntp command.  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server ip 1 10.1.0.19  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server timezone +8  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server daylight-saving  
Enter Daylight saving from which month<1-12>: 3  
and which day<1-31>: 31  
Enter Daylight saving end to which month<1-12>: 10  
and which day<1-31>: 31  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show sntp  
SNTP Information  
=========================================================  
Service State  
: Enabled  
SNTP (server 1) IP : 10.1.0.19  
SNTP (server 2) IP : 192.43.244.18  
Current Time  
Time Zone  
: 19 : 35, Oct 10th, 2003  
: +8 (TAIPEI, BEIJING)  
Daylight Saving  
: Enabled, from Mar, 31st to Oct, 31st  
=========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.4.11.2.2 CLI Commands for the System Clock  
The following example shows how to manually set the system time when SNTP  
server support is disabled on the AP.  
Enterprise AP(config)#no sntp-server enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server date-time  
Enter Year<1970-2100>: 2003  
Enter Month<1-12>: 10  
Enter Day<1-31>: 10  
Enter Hour<0-23>: 18  
Enter Min<0-59>: 35  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
4.4.12 RSSI  
RSSI is not applicable for the current release.  
78  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP  
4.5  
SNMP  
You can use a network management application such as HP’s OpenView to  
manage the AP via the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) from a  
network management station. To implement SNMP management, the AP must  
have an IP address and subnet mask, configured either manually or dynamically.  
Once an IP address has been configured, appropriate SNMP communities and  
trap receivers should be configured.  
Community names are used to control management access to SNMP stations, as  
well as to authorize SNMP stations to receive trap messages from the AP. To  
communicate with the AP, a management station must first submit a valid  
community name for authentication. You therefore need to assign community  
names to specified users or user groups and set the access level.  
Figure 4-15: SNMP  
SNMP – Enables or disables SNMP management access and also enables the AP to  
send SNMP traps (notifications). (Default: Disable)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Location – A text string that describes the system location. (Maximum length: 255  
characters)  
Contact – A text string that describes the system contact. (Maximum length: 255  
characters)  
Community Name (Read Only) – Defines the SNMP community access string that  
has read-only access. Authorized management stations are only able to retrieve  
MIB objects. (Maximum length: 23 characters, case sensitive; Default: public)  
Community Name (Read/Write) – Defines the SNMP community access string that  
has read/write access. Authorized management stations are able to both retrieve  
and modify MIB objects. (Maximum length: 23 characters, case sensitive;  
Default: private)  
Trap Destination (1 to 4) – Enables recipients (up to four) of SNMP notifications.  
Trap Destination IP Address – Specifies the recipient of SNMP notifications.  
Enter the IP address or the host name. (Host Name: 1 to 63 characters, case  
sensitive)  
Trap Destination Community Name – The community string sent with the  
notification operation. (Maximum length: 23 characters, case sensitive;  
Default: public)  
Engine ID – Sets the engine identifier for the SNMPv3 agent that resides on the AP.  
This engine protects against message replay, delay, and redirection. The engine ID  
is also used in combination with user passwords to generate the security keys for  
authenticating and encrypting SNMPv3 packets. A default engine ID is  
automatically generated that is unique to the AP. (Range: 10 to 64 hexadecimal  
characters)  
NOTE  
If the local engine ID is deleted or changed, all SNMP users will be cleared. All existing users will  
need to be re-configured.  
80  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SNMP  
Figure 4-16: Trap Configuration  
Trap Configuration – Allows selection of specific SNMP notifications to send. The  
following items are available:  
sysSystemUp - The AP is up and running.  
sysSystemDown - The AP is about to shutdown and reboot.  
sysRadiusServerChanged - The AP has changed from the primary RADIUS  
server to the secondary, or from the secondary to the primary.  
sysConfigFileVersionChanged - The AP’s configuration file has been changed.  
dot11StationAssociation - A client station has successfully associated with the  
AP.  
dot11StationReAssociation - A client station has successfully re-associated  
with the AP.  
dot11StationAuthentication - A client station has been successfully  
authenticated.  
dot11StationRequestFail - A client station has failed association,  
re-association, or authentication.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
dot11InterfaceBFail - The 802.11b interface has failed.  
dot1xMacAddrAuthSuccess - A client station has successfully authenticated its  
MAC address with the RADIUS server.  
dot1xMacAddrAuthFail - A client station has failed MAC address  
authentication with the RADIUS server.  
dot1xAuthNotInitiated - A client station did not initiate 802.1X authentication.  
dot1xAuthSuccess - A 802.1X client station has been successfully  
authenticated by the RADIUS server.  
dot1xAuthFail - A 802.1X client station has failed RADIUS authentication.  
dot1xSuppAuthenticated - A supplicant station has been successfully  
authenticated by the RADIUS server  
localMacAddrAuthSuccess - A client station has successfully authenticated its  
MAC address with the local database on the AP.  
localMacAddrAuthFail - A client station has failed authentication with the local  
MAC address database on the AP.  
iappStationRoamedFrom - A client station has roamed from another AP  
(identified by its IP address).  
iappStationRoamedTo - A client station has roamed to another AP (identified by  
its IP address).  
iappContextDataSent - A client station’s Context Data has been sent to another  
AP with which the station has associated.  
sntpServerFail - The AP has failed to set the time from the configured SNTP  
server.  
wirelessExternalAntenna - An external antenna has been enabled.  
dot11WirelessStationDeauthenticate - A client station has de-authenticated  
from the network.  
82  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP  
dot11StationDisassociate - A client station no longer associates with the  
network.  
dot11StationAuthenticateFail - A client station has tried and failed to  
authenticate to the network.  
Enable All Traps - Click the button to enable all the available traps.  
Disable All Traps - Click the button to disable all the available traps.  
CLI Commands for SNMP and Trap Configuration  
4.5.0.0.1  
Use the snmp-server enable server command from the global configuration mode  
to enable the SNMP agent. Use the snmp-server location and snmp-server  
contact commands to indicate the physical location of the wi and define a system  
contact. To set the read-only and read/write community names, use the  
snmp-server community command. Use the snmp-server host command to  
define a trap receiver host and the snmp-server trap command to enable or  
disable specific traps.  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server enable server  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server community alpha rw  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server community beta ro  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server location WC-19  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server contact Paul  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server host 192.168.1.9 alpha  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server trap dot11StationAssociation  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
To view the current SNMP settings, use the show snmp command.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP#show snmp  
SNMP Information  
==============================================  
Service State  
Community (ro)  
Community (rw)  
Location  
: Enable  
: *****  
: *****  
: WC-19  
: Paul  
Contact  
EngineId :80:00:07:e5:80:00:00:2e:62:00:00:00:18  
EngineBoots:1  
Trap Destinations:  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
192.168.1.9, Community: *****, State: Enabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
dot11InterfaceAGFail Enabled  
dot11StationAssociation Enabled dot11StationAuthentication  
dot11StationReAssociation Enabled  
dot1xAuthFail Enabled  
dot11InterfaceBFail  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
dot11StationRequestFail  
dot1xAuthNotInitiated  
dot1xMacAddrAuthFail  
iappContextDataSent  
iappStationRoamedTo  
localMacAddrAuthSuccess  
dot1xAuthSuccess Enabled  
dot1xMacAddrAuthSuccess Enabled  
iappStationRoamedFrom Enabled  
localMacAddrAuthFail Enabled  
iappContextDataSent  
Enabled  
dot1XSuppAuthenticated Enabled  
dot11InterfaceAFail Enabled  
wirelessExternalAntenna Enabled  
dot11InterfaceGFail Enabled  
pppLogonFail Enabled  
sntpServerFail  
radiusServerChanged  
systemUp  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
configFileVersionChanged Enabled  
systemDown Enabled  
=============================================  
Enterprise AP#  
84  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
4.6  
Radio Interface  
The 802.11g interface includes configuration options for radio signal  
characteristics and wireless security features. The configuration options are  
nearly identical, and are therefore both covered in this section of the manual.  
NOTE  
802.11g is backward compatible with 802.11b. The 802.11g interface is configured independently  
under the Radio Interface G: 802.11b/g web pages.  
The radio supports up to four virtual AP (VAP) interfaces numbered 0 to 3. Each  
VAP functions as a separate AP, and can be configured with its own Service Set  
Identification (SSID) and security settings. However, most radio signal parameters  
apply to all four VAP interfaces.  
The VAPs function similar to a VLAN, with each VAP mapped to its own VLAN ID.  
Traffic to specific VAPs can be segregated based on user groups or application  
traffic. Each VAP can have up to 64 wireless clients, whereby the clients associate  
with these VAPs the same as they would with a physical AP.  
NOTE  
The radio channel settings for the AP are limited by local regulations, which determine the number  
of channels that are available. Refer to “Specifications” on page 4 for additional information on  
the maximum number channels available.  
4.6.1 Radio Settings G (802.11g)  
The IEEE 802.11g standard operates within the 2.4 GHz band at up to 54 Mbps.  
Also note that because the IEEE 802.11g standard is an extension of the IEEE  
802.11b standard, it allows clients with 802.11b wireless network cards to  
associate to an 802.11g access point.  
First configure the radio settings that apply to the individual VAPs (Virtual Access  
Point) and the common radio settings that apply to all of the 802.11g interfaces.  
After you have configured the radio settings, go to the Security page under the  
802.g Interface (see “Security” on page 4-102.), enable the radio service for any of  
the VAP interfaces, and then set an SSID to identify the wireless network service  
provided by each VAP. Remember that only clients with the same SSID can  
associate with a VAP.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
NOTE  
You must first enable VAP interface 0 before the other interfaces can be enabled.  
For information on configuring 802.11g settings, refer to the following sections:  
4.6.1.1  
Configuring VAP Radio Settings  
To configure VAP radio settings, select the Radio Settings page.  
Figure 4-17: Radio Settings Page  
86  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Radio Interface  
Figure 4-18: Radio Settings  
Default VLAN ID – The VLAN ID assigned to wireless clients associated to the VAP  
interface that are not assigned to a specific VLAN by RADIUS server configuration.  
(Default: 1)  
Closed System – When enabled, the VAP interface does not include its SSID in  
beacon messages. Nor does it respond to probe requests from clients that do not  
include a fixed SSID. (Default: Disable)  
Authentication Timeout Interval – The time within which the client should finish  
authentication before authentication times out. (Range: 5-60 minutes; Default: 60  
minutes)  
Association Timeout Interval – The idle time interval (when no frames are sent)  
after which a client is disassociated from the VAP interface. (Range: 5-60 minutes;  
Default: 30 minutes)  
WPA2 PMKSA Life Time – WPA2 provides fast roaming for authenticated clients by  
retaining keys and other security settings in a cache for each VAP. In this way,  
when clients roam back into a VAP they had previously been using,  
re-authentication is not required. When a WPA2 client is first authenticated, it  
receives a Pairwise Master Key (PMK) that is used to generate the other keys used  
for unicast data encryption. This key and other client information form a client  
Security Association (SA) that the VAP holds in a cache. When the lifetime expires,  
the security association and keys are deleted from the cache. If the client returns  
to an access point after the association has been deleted, it will require full  
re-authentication. (Range: 1-1440 minutes; Default: 720 minutes)  
4.6.1.1.1  
CLI Commands for the Configuring the VAPs  
From the global configuration mode, enter the interface wireless g command to  
access the 802.11g radio interface. From the 802.11g interface mode, you can  
access radio settings that apply to all VAP interfaces. To access a specific VAP  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
interface (numbered 0 to 3), use the vap command. You can configure a name for  
each interface using the description command. You can also use the  
closed-system command to stop sending the SSID in beacon messages. Set any  
other VAP parameters and radio setting as required before enabling the VAP  
interface (with the no shutdown command). To view the current 802.11g radio  
settings for the VAP interface, use the show interface wireless g [0-3] command  
as shown on page 215.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#vap 0  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#description RD-AP#3  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#vlan-id 1  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#closed-system  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#authentication-timeout-  
interval 30  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#association-timeout-  
interval 20  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#max-association 32  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#pmksa-lifetime 900  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
4.6.1.2  
Configuring Rogue AP Detection  
To configure Rouge AP detection, select the Radio Settings page, and scroll down  
to the Rouge AP section.  
Figure 4-19: Rouge AP Section of Radio Settings page  
Rogue AP – A “rogue AP” is either an AP that is not authorized to participate in the  
wireless network, or an AP that does not have the correct security configuration.  
Rogue APs can allow unauthorized access to the network, or fool client stations  
into mistakenly associating with them and thereby blocking access to network  
resources.  
The AP can be configured to periodically scan all radio channels and find other  
APs within range. A database of nearby APs is maintained where any rogue APs  
can be identified. During a scan, Syslog messages (see “Enabling System Logging”  
88  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Radio Interface  
on page 74) are sent for each AP detected. Rogue APs can be identified by  
unknown BSSID (MAC address) or SSID configuration.  
AP Detection – Enables the periodic scanning for other APs. (Default: Disable)  
AP Scan Interval – Sets the time between each rogue AP scan. (Range: 30  
-10080 minutes; Default: 720 minutes)  
AP Scan Duration – Sets the length of time for each rogue AP scan. A long scan  
duration time will detect more access points in the area, but causes more  
disruption to client access. (Range: 100 -1000 milliseconds; Default: 350  
milliseconds)  
Rogue AP Authenticate – Enables or disables RADIUS authentication. Enabling  
RADIUS Authentication allows the AP to discover rogue APs. With RADIUS  
authentication enabled, the access point checks the MAC address/ Basic  
Service Set Identifier (BSSID) of each access point that it finds against a  
RADIUS server to determine whether the access point is allowed. With RADIUS  
authentication disabled, the access point can detect its neighboring APs only;  
it cannot identify whether the APs are allowed or are rogues. If you enable  
RADIUS authentication, you must configure a RADIUS server for this AP (see  
Scan AP Now – Starts an immediate rogue AP scan on the radio interface.  
(Default: Disable)  
NOTE  
While the AP scans a channel for rogue APs, wireless clients will not be able to connect to the  
access point. Therefore, avoid frequent scanning or scans of a long duration unless there is a  
reason to believe that more intensive scanning is required to find a rogue AP.  
4.6.1.2.1  
CLI Commands for Rogue AP Detection  
From the global configuration mode, enter the interface wireless command to  
access the 802.11g radio interface. From the wireless interface mode, use the  
rogue-ap enable command to enable rogue AP detection. Set the duration and  
interval times with the rogue-ap duration and rogue-ap interval commands. If  
required, start an immediate scan using the rogue-ap scan command. To view the  
database of detected access points, use the show rogue-ap command from the  
Exec level.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface wireless g  
Enter Wireless configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap enable  
configure either syslog or trap or both to receive the rogue APs detected.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap duration 200  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap interval 120  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap scan  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogueApDetect Completed (Radio G) : 5 APs detected  
rogueAPDetect (Radio G): refreshing ap database now  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show rogue-ap  
802.11g Channel : Rogue AP Status  
AP Address(BSSID)  
SSID Channel(MHz) RSSI  
=======================================================  
00-04-e2-2a-37-23  
00-04-e2-2a-37-3d  
00-04-e2-2a-37-49  
00-90-d1-08-9d-a7  
00-30-f1-fb-31-f4  
Enterprise AP#  
WLAN1AP 11(2462 MHz) 17  
ANY  
WLAN1AP  
WLAN1AP  
WLAN  
7(2442 MHz) 42  
9(2452 MHz) 42  
1(2412 MHz) 12  
6(2437 MHz) 16  
To configure the remaining 802.11g radio settings, select the Radio Settings  
page.  
90  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
Figure 4-20: Radio Setting Configuration  
Radio Channel – The radio channel that the AP uses to communicate with wireless  
clients. When multiple APs are deployed in the same area, set the channel on  
neighboring access points at least four channels apart to avoid interference with  
each other. This means that you can deploy up to three APs in the same area. (In  
the United States you should use channels 1, 6 and 11. In most of Europe you  
can also use channels 2, 7 and 12, or 3, 8 and 13).  
Also note that the channel for wireless clients is automatically set to the same as  
that used by the access point to which it is linked. In Turbo Mode (Super G  
enabled) only channel 6 should be used. (Default: Channel 6)  
Table 4-4: Channels Assignment  
Channel NumberV  
Frequency (GHz)  
1
2
3
4
5
2.412  
2.417  
2.422  
2.427  
2.432  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Table 4-4: Channels Assignment  
Channel NumberV  
Frequency (GHz)  
2.437  
6
7
2.442  
8
2.447  
9
2.452  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
2.457  
2.462  
2.467  
2.472  
2.482  
Auto Channel Select – Enables the AP to automatically select an unoccupied radio  
channel. (Default: Enabled)  
NOTE  
Check your country’s regulations to see if Auto Channel can be disabled.  
Transmit Power – Adjusts the power of the radio signals transmitted from the  
access point. The higher the transmission power, the farther the transmission  
range. Power selection is not just a trade off between coverage area and maximum  
supported clients. You also have to ensure that high-power signals do not  
interfere with the operation of other radio devices in the service area. (Options:  
100%, 50%, 25%, 12%, minimum; Default: 100%)  
Maximum Station Data Rate – The maximum data rate at which the access  
point transmits unicast packets on the wireless interface. The maximum  
transmission distance is affected by the data rate. The lower the data rate,  
the longer the transmission distance. (Default: 54 Mbps)  
Antenna ID – Selects  
the antenna to be used  
by the AP. The optional  
external antennas that  
are certified for use  
with the access point are listed in the drop-down menu. Selecting the correct  
92  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
antenna ID ensures that the AP's radio transmissions are within regulatory power  
limits for the country of operation. In the current release, select id-0x0108,  
module-ACC04-05427A Omni-Directional Ant from the list for the 8dBi omni  
antenna(s). The unit will not transmit until an antenna is selected.  
(Default:id=0x0000, module=NA)  
NOTE  
The Antenna ID must be selected in conjunction with the Antenna Control Method to configure  
proper use of any of the antenna options.  
Antenna Control Method - Selects the use of two antennas operating in diversity  
mode or a single antenna. (Default: Diversity)  
Diversity: The radio uses two identical antennas in a diversity system.  
Right: The radio uses a single antenna on the right side. Select this method  
when using an optional external antenna that is connected to the right  
antenna connector.  
Left: The radio uses a single antenna on the left side. Select this method when  
using an optional external antenna that is connected to the left antenna  
connector.  
Antenna Location – Selects the mounting location of the antenna in use; either  
Indoor or Outdoor. Selecting the correct location ensures that the access point  
only uses radio channels that are permitted in the country of operation.  
(Default: Indoor)  
MIC Mode – The Michael Integrity Check (MIC) is part of the Temporal Key  
Integrity Protocol (TKIP) encryption used in WiFi Protected Access (WPA) security.  
The MIC calculation is performed in the access point for each transmitted packet  
and this can impact throughput and performance. The AP supports a choice of  
software or hardware MIC calculation. The performance of the AP can be improved  
by selecting the best method for the specific deployment. (Default: Software)  
Hardware: Provides best performance when the number of supported clients is  
less than 27.  
Software: Provides the best performance for a large number of clients on one  
radio interface. Throughput may be reduced when the 802.11g interface  
supports a high number of clients simultaneously.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Super G – The Atheros proprietary Super G performance enhancements are  
supported by the access point. These enhancements provide increased  
throughput for connections to Atheros-compatible clients through bursting,  
compression, and fast frames (concatenation). (Default: Disabled)  
Radio Mode – Selects the operating mode for the 802.11g wireless interface.  
(Default: 802.11b+g)  
802.11b+g: Both 802.11b and 802.11g clients can communicate with the  
access point (up to 54 Mbps).  
802.11b only: Both 802.11b and 802.11g clients can communicate with the  
access point, but 802.11g clients can only transfer data at 802.11b standard  
rates (up to 11 Mbps).  
802.11g only: Only 802.11g clients can communicate with the access point (up  
to 54 Mbps).  
Auto Channel Select – Enables the access point to automatically select an  
unoccupied radio channel. (Default: Enabled)  
Preamble – Sets the length of the signal preamble that is used at the start of a  
data transmission. (Default: Long)  
Long: Sets the preamble to long (192 microseconds). Using a long preamble  
ensures the access point can support all 802.11b and 802.11g clients.  
Short or Long: Sets the preamble according to the capability of clients that are  
currently associated. Uses a short preamble (96 microseconds) if all associated  
clients can support it, otherwise a long preamble is used. The access point can  
increase data throughput when using a short preamble, but will only use a  
short preamble if it determines that all associated clients support it.  
Beacon Interval – The rate at which beacon signals are transmitted from the  
access point. The beacon signals allow wireless clients to maintain contact with  
the access point. They may also carry power-management information.  
(Range: 20-1000 TUs; Default: 100 TUs)  
Data Beacon Rate – The rate at which stations in sleep mode must wake up to  
receive broadcast/multicast transmissions.  
Known also as the Delivery Traffic Indication Map (DTIM) interval, it indicates how  
often the MAC layer forwards broadcast/multicast traffic, which is necessary to  
wake up stations that are using Power Save mode. The default value of 2 indicates  
94  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Radio Interface  
that the access point will save all broadcast/multicast frames for the Basic  
Service Set (BSS) and forward them after every second beacon. Using smaller  
DTIM intervals delivers broadcast/multicast frames in a more timely manner,  
causing stations in Power Save mode to wake up more often and drain power  
faster. Using higher DTIM values reduces the power used by stations in Power  
Save mode, but delays the transmission of broadcast/multicast frames.  
(Range: 1-255 beacons; Default: 1 beacon)  
Multicast Data Rate – The maximum data rate at which the access point  
transmits multicast and broadcast packets on the wireless interface. (Options:  
24, 12, 6 Mbps; Default: 6 Mbps)  
Fragmentation Length – Configures the minimum packet size that can be  
fragmented when passing through the access point. Fragmentation of the PDUs  
(Package Data Unit) can increase the reliability of transmissions because it  
increases the probability of a successful transmission due to smaller frame size. If  
there is significant interference present, or collisions due to high network  
utilization, try setting the fragment size to send smaller fragments. This will speed  
up the retransmission of smaller frames. However, it is more efficient to set the  
fragment size larger if very little or no interference is present because it requires  
overhead to send multiple frames. (Range: 256-2346 bytes; Default: 2346 bytes)  
RTS Threshold – Sets the packet size threshold at which a Request to Send (RTS)  
signal must be sent to a receiving station prior to the sending station starting  
communications. The access point sends RTS frames to a receiving station to  
negotiate the sending of a data frame. After receiving an RTS frame, the station  
sends a CTS (clear to send) frame to notify the sending station that it can start  
sending data.  
If the RTS threshold is set to 0, the access point always sends RTS signals. If set  
to 2347, the access point never sends RTS signals. If set to any other value, and  
the packet size equals or exceeds the RTS threshold, the RTS/CTS (Request to  
Send / Clear to Send) mechanism will be enabled.  
The APs contending for the medium may not be aware of each other. The  
RTS/CTS mechanism can solve this “Hidden Node Problem.” (Range: 0-2347  
bytes: Default: 2347 bytes)  
4.6.1.2.2  
CLI Commands for the 802.11g Wireless Interface  
From the global configuration mode, enter the interface wireless g command to  
access the 802.11g radio interface. The 802.11g radio can be forced to an  
802.11g-only, 802.11b-only, or mixed 802.11b/g operating mode using the  
radio-mode command. You should set the desired operating mode before  
configuring channel settings (the default is mixed 802.11b/g operation). Select a  
radio channel or set selection to Auto using the channel command. Set any  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
other radio settings as required before enabling the VAP interface (with the no  
shutdown command). To view the current 802.11g radio settings for the VAP  
interface, use the show interface wireless g [0~3] command as shown on  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface wireless g  
Enter Wireless configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#radio-mode g  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#channel auto  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#transmit-power full  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#super-g  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#preamble short  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
4.6.1.2.3  
CLI Commands for the Radio Settings  
From the global configuration mode, enter the interface wireless g command to  
access the 802.11g radio interface. From the 802.11g interface mode, you can  
access radio settings that apply to all VAP interfaces. Use the turbo command to  
enable this feature before setting the radio channel with the channel command.  
Set any other radio setting as required before enabling the VAP interface (with the  
no shutdown command). To view the current 802.11g radio settings for the VAP  
interface, use the show interface wireless g [0~3] command as shown on  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface wireless g  
Enter Wireless configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#channel 42  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#transmit-power full  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#speed 9  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#antenna id 0000  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#antenna control right  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#antenna location indoor  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#mic_mode hardware  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#super-g  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#beacon-interval 150  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#beacon-interval 150  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#dtim-period 5  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#multicast-data-rate 6  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#fragmentation-length 512  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rts-threshold 256  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
4.6.1.3  
Configuring WiFi Multimedia  
Wireless networks offer an equal opportunity for all devices to transmit data from  
any type of application. Although this is acceptable for most applications,  
multimedia applications (with audio and video) are particularly sensitive to the  
96  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Radio Interface  
delay and throughput variations that result from this “equal opportunity” wireless  
access method. For multimedia applications to run well over a wireless network, a  
Quality of Service (QoS) mechanism is required to prioritize traffic types and  
provide an “enhanced opportunity” wireless access method.  
The access point implements QoS using the WiFi Multimedia (WMM) standard.  
Using WMM, the access point is able to prioritize traffic and optimize performance  
when multiple applications compete for wireless network bandwidth at the same  
time. WMM employs techniques that are a subset of the developing IEEE 802.11e  
QoS standard and it enables the access point to inter operate with both WMM-  
enabled clients and other devices that may lack any WMM functionality.  
Access Categories — WMM defines four access categories (ACs): voice, video, best  
effort, and background. These categories correspond to traffic priority levels and  
are mapped to IEEE 802.1D priority tags (see Table 4-5). The direct mapping of  
the four ACs to 802.1D priorities is specifically intended to facilitate inter  
operability with other wired network QoS policies. While the four ACs are specified  
for specific types of traffic, WMM allows the priority levels to be configured to  
match any network-wide QoS policy. WMM also specifies a protocol that access  
points can use to communicate the configured traffic priority levels to  
QoS-enabled wireless clients.  
Table 4-5: WMM Access Categories  
Access  
Category  
WMM  
Designation  
Description  
802.1D  
Tags  
AC_VO (AC3)  
AC_VI (AC2)  
AC_BE (AC0)  
Voice  
Highest priority, minimum delay. Time-sensitive data such as  
VoIP (Voice over IP) calls.  
7, 6  
5, 4  
0, 3  
Video  
High priority, minimum delay. Time-sensitive data such as  
streaming video.  
Best Effort  
Normal priority, medium delay and throughput. Data only  
affected by long delays. Data from applications or devices that  
lack QoS capabilities.  
AC_BK (AC1)  
Background  
Lowest priority. Data with no delay or throughput  
requirements, such as bulk data transfers.  
2, 1  
WMM Operation — WMM uses traffic priority based on the four ACs; Voice,  
Video, Best Effort, and Background. The higher the AC priority, the higher the  
probability that data is transmitted.  
When the access point forwards traffic, WMM adds data packets to four  
independent transmit queues, one for each AC, depending on the 802.1D priority  
tag of the packet. Data packets without a priority tag are always added to the Best  
Effort AC queue. From the four queues, an internal “virtual” collision resolution  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
mechanism first selects data with the highest priority to be granted a transmit  
opportunity. Then the same collision resolution mechanism is used externally to  
determine which device has access to the wireless medium.  
For each AC queue, the collision resolution mechanism is dependent on two  
timing parameters:  
AIFSN (Arbitration Inter-Frame Space Number), a number used to calculate  
the minimum time between data frames  
CW (Contention Window), a number used to calculate a random backoff time  
After a collision detection, a backoff wait time is calculated. The total wait time is  
the sum of a minimum wait time (Arbitration Inter-Frame Space, or AIFS)  
determined from the AIFSN, and a random backoff time calculated from a value  
selected from zero to the CW. The CW value varies within a configurable range. It  
starts at CWMin and doubles after every collision up to a maximum value,  
CWMax. After a successful transmission, the CW value is reset to its CWMin  
value.  
Figure 4-21: WMM Backoff Wait Times  
For high-priority traffic, the AIFSN and CW values are smaller. The smaller values  
equate to less backoff and wait time, and therefore more transmit opportunities.  
To configure WMM, select the Radio Settings page, and scroll down to the WMM  
configuration settings.  
98  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
Figure 4-22: WMM Configuration Settings  
WMM – Sets the WMM operational mode on the AP. When enabled, the  
parameters for each AC queue will be employed on the access point and QoS  
capabilities are advertised to WMM-enabled clients. (Default: Support)  
Disable: WMM is disabled.  
Support: WMM will be used for any associated device that supports this  
feature. Devices that do not support this feature may still associate with the  
access point.  
Required: WMM must be supported on any device trying to associated with the  
access point. Devices that do not support this feature will not be allowed to  
associate with the access point.  
WMM Acknowledge Policy – By default, all wireless data transmissions require  
the sender to wait for an acknowledgement from the receiver. WMM allows the  
acknowledgement wait time to be turned off for each Access Category (AC).  
Although this increases data throughput, it can also result in a high number of  
errors when traffic levels are heavy. (Default: Acknowledge)  
WMM BSS Parameters – These parameters apply to the wireless clients.  
WMM AP Parameters – These parameters apply to the access point.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
logCWMin (Minimum Contention Window) – The initial upper limit of the  
random backoff wait time before wireless medium access can be attempted.  
The initial wait time is a random value between zero and the CWMin value.  
Specify the CWMin value in the range 0-15 microseconds. Note that the  
CWMin value must be equal or less than the CWMax value.  
logCWMax (Maximum Contention Window) – The maximum upper limit of the  
random backoff wait time before wireless medium access can be attempted.  
The contention window is doubled after each detected collision up to the  
CWMax value. Specify the CWMax value in the range 0-15 microseconds. Note  
that the CWMax value must be greater or equal to the CWMin value.  
AIFS (Arbitration Inter-Frame Space) – The minimum amount of wait time  
before the next data transmission attempt. Specify the AIFS value in the range  
0-15 microseconds.  
TXOP Limit (Transmit Opportunity Limit) – The maximum time an AC  
transmit queue has access to the wireless medium. When an AC queue is  
granted a transmit opportunity, it can transmit data for a time up to the  
TxOpLimit. This data bursting greatly improves the efficiency for high  
data-rate traffic. Specify a value in the range 0-65535 microseconds.  
Admission Control – The admission control mode for the access category.  
When enabled, clients are blocked from using the access category. (Default:  
Disabled)  
4.6.1.3.1  
CLI Commands for WMM  
Enter interface wireless mode and type wmm required for clients that want to  
associate with the access point. The wmm-acknowledge-policy command is used  
to enable or disable a policy for each access category. The wmmparms command  
defines detailed WMM parameters.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#wmm required  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#wmm-acknowledge-policy 0 noack  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#wmmparams ap 0 4 6 3 1 1  
To view the current 802.11g radio settings for the VAP interface, use the show  
interface wireless g [0-3] command.  
100  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
Enterprise AP#show interface wireless g 0  
Wireless Interface Information  
=============================================================  
--------------------Identification---------------------------  
Description  
SSID  
Turbo Mode  
Channel  
: Enterprise 802.11g Access Point  
: VAP_TEST_11G 0  
: DISABLED  
: 36 (AUTO)  
Status  
: DISABLED  
MAC Address  
: 00:12:cf:05:95:0c  
----------------802.11 Parameters---------------------------  
Transmit Power  
: FULL (16 dBm)  
: 54Mbps  
: 6Mbps  
: 2346 bytes  
: 2347 bytes  
: 100 TUs  
Max Station Data Rate  
Multicast Data Rate  
Fragmentation Threshold  
RTS Threshold  
Beacon Interval  
Authentication Timeout Interval : 60 Mins  
Association Timeout Interval  
DTIM Interval  
Maximum Association  
MIC Mode  
Super A  
VLAN ID  
: 30 Mins  
: 1 beacon  
: 64 stations  
: Software  
: Disabled  
: 1  
----------------Security-------------------------------------  
Closed System  
Multicast cipher  
WPA clients  
WPA Key Mgmt Mode  
WPA PSK Key Type  
Encryption  
Default Transmit Key  
Common Static Keys  
: Disabled  
: WEP  
: TKIP and AES  
: PRE SHARED KEY  
: PASSPHRASE  
: DISABLED  
: 1  
: Key 1: EMPTY  
Key 3: EMPTY  
: OPEN  
Key 2: EMPTY  
Key 4: EMPTY  
Authentication Type  
----------------802.1x---------------------------------------  
802.1x  
:
Broadcast Key Refresh Rate  
Session Key Refresh Rate  
802.1x Session Timeout Value  
: 30 min  
: 30 min  
: 0 min  
----------------Antenna--------------------------------------  
Antenna Control method  
Antenna ID  
Antenna Location  
: Diversity  
: 0x0000(Default Antenna)  
: Indoor  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
----------------Quality of Service---------------------------  
WMM Mode  
: SUPPORTED  
WMM Acknowledge Policy  
AC0(Best Effort)  
AC1(Background)  
AC2(Video)  
: Ack  
: Acknowledge  
: Acknowledge  
: Acknowledge  
AC3(Voice)  
WMM BSS Parameters  
AC0(Best Effort)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 10 AIFSN: 3  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
AC1(Background)  
AC2(Video)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 10 AIFSN: 7  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
: logCwMin: 3 logCwMax: 4 AIFSN: 2  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 3.008 ms  
AC3(Voice)  
: logCwMin: 2 logCwMax: 3 AIFSN: 2  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 1.504 ms  
WMM AP Parameters  
AC0(Best Effort)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 6 AIFSN: 3  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
AC1(Background)  
AC2(Video)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 10 AIFSN: 7  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
: logCwMin: 3 logCwMax: 4 AIFSN: 1  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 3.008 ms  
AC3(Voice)  
: logCwMin: 2 logCwMax: 3 AIFSN: 1  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 1.504 ms  
=============================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.6.2 Security  
The access point is configured by default as an “open system,” which broadcasts a  
beacon signal including the configured SSID. Wireless clients with an SSID setting  
of “any” can read the SSID from the beacon and automatically set their SSID to  
allow immediate connection to the nearest access point.  
To improve wireless network security, you have to implement two main functions:  
Authentication: It must be verified that clients attempting to connect to the  
network are authorized users.  
Traffic Encryption: Data passing between the access point and clients must be  
protected from interception and eavesdropping.  
102  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Radio Interface  
For a more secure network, the AP can implement one or a combination of the  
following security mechanisms:  
Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) page 103  
IEEE 802.1X page 118  
Wireless MAC address filtering page 58  
WiFi Protected Access (WPA or WPA2) page 112  
Both WEP and WPA security settings are configurable separately for each virtual  
access point (VAP) interface. MAC address filtering, and RADIUS server settings  
are global and apply to all VAP interfaces.  
The security mechanisms that may be employed depend on the level of security  
required, the network and management resources available, and the software  
support provided on wireless clients.  
A summary of wireless security considerations is listed in Table 4-6.  
Table 4-6: Wireless Security Considerations  
Security  
Client Support  
Implementation Considerations  
Mechanism  
WEP  
Built-in support on all 802.11g  
devices  
Provides only weak security  
Requires manual key management  
WEP over 802.1X  
Requires 802.1X client support in  
system or by add-in software  
Provides dynamic key rotation for improved WEP  
security  
(support provided in Windows  
2000 SP3 or later and Windows  
XP)  
Requires configured RADIUS server  
802.1X EAP type may require management of digital  
certificates for clients and server  
MAC Address  
Filtering  
Uses the MAC address of client  
network card  
Provides only weak user authentication  
Management of authorized MAC addresses  
Can be combined with other methods for improved  
security  
Optionally configured RADIUS server  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Table 4-6: Wireless Security Considerations  
Client Support Implementation Considerations  
Security  
Mechanism  
WPA over 802.1X  
Mode  
Requires WPA-enabled system  
and network card driver  
Provides robust security in WPA-only mode  
(i.e., WPA clients only)  
(native support provided in  
Windows XP)  
Offers support for legacy WEP clients, but with  
increased security risk (i.e., WEP authentication  
keys disabled)  
Requires configured RADIUS server  
802.1X EAP type may require management of digital  
certificates for clients and server  
WPA PSK Mode  
Requires WPA-enabled system  
and network card driver  
Provides good security in small networks  
Requires manual management of pre-shared key  
(native support provided in  
Windows XP)  
WPA2 with 802.1X Requires WPA-enabled system  
and network card driver (native  
Provides the strongest security in WPA2-only mode  
Provides robust security in mixed mode for WPA and  
support provided in Windows XP)  
WPA2 clients  
Offers fast roaming for time-sensitive client  
applications  
Requires configured RADIUS server  
802.1X EAP type may require management of digital  
certificates for clients and server  
Clients may require hardware upgrade to be WPA2  
compliant  
WPA2 PSK Mode  
Requires WPA-enabled system  
and network card driver (native  
support provided in Windows XP)  
Provides robust security in small networks  
Requires manual management of pre-shared key  
Clients may require hardware upgrade to be WPA2  
compliant  
NOTE  
You must enable data encryption through the web or CLI in order to enable all types of encryption  
(WEP, TKIP, or AES) in the access point.  
The AP can simultaneously support clients using various different security  
mechanisms. The configuration for these security combinations are outlined in  
the following table. Note that MAC address authentication can be configured  
104  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
independently to work with all security mechanisms and is indicated separately in  
the table. Required RADIUS server support is also listed.  
Table 4-7: Security Combinations  
a
Client Security  
Combination  
Configuration Summary  
MAC  
Authentication  
RADIUS  
Server  
b
3
No encryption and no  
authentication  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local, RADIUS, or  
Disabled  
Yes  
Authentication: Open System  
Encryption: Disable  
802.1x: Disable  
c
Static WEP only (with  
or without shared key  
authentication)  
Enter 1 to 4 WEP keys  
Local, RADIUS, or  
Disabled  
Yes  
Select a WEP transmit key for the interface  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Authentication: Shared Key or Open System  
Encryption: Enable  
802.1x: Disable  
d
Dynamic WEP  
(802.1x) only  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local, RADIUS, or  
Disabled  
Yes  
Authentication: Open System  
Encryption: Enable  
802.1x: Required  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
802.1x WPA only  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local only  
Yes  
Authentication: WPA  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Required  
Cipher Suite: TKIP  
802.1x: Required  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
WPA Pre-Shared Key  
only  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local only  
No  
Authentication: WPA-PSK  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Required  
Cipher Configuration: TKIP  
802.1x: Disable  
WPA Pre-shared Key Type: Hexadicmal or  
Alphanumeric  
Enter a WPA Pre-shared key  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Table 4-7: Security Combinations  
a
Client Security  
Combination  
Configuration Summary  
MAC  
Authentication  
RADIUS  
Server  
b
Static and dynamic  
(802.1x) WEP keys  
Enter 1 to 4 WEP keys  
Local, RADIUS, or  
Disabled  
Yes  
Select a WEP transmit key  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Authentication: Open System  
Encryption: Enable  
802.1x: Supported  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
Dynamic WEP and  
802.1x WPA  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local or Disabled  
Yes  
Authentication: WPA  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Supported  
Cipher Suite: WEP  
802.1x: Required  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
Static and dynamic  
(802.1x) WEP keys  
and 802.1x WPA  
Enter 1 to 4 WEP keys  
Local or Disabled  
Yes  
Select a WEP transmit key  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Authentication: WPA  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Supported  
Cipher Suite: WEP  
802.1x: Supported  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
802.1x WPA2 only  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local or Disabled  
Yes  
Authentication: WPA2  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Required  
Cipher Suite: AES-CCMP  
802.1x: Required  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
106  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
Table 4-7: Security Combinations  
a
Client Security  
Combination  
Configuration Summary  
MAC  
Authentication  
RADIUS  
Server  
b
WPA2 Pre-Shared Key  
only  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local or Disabled  
No  
Authentication: WPA2-PSK  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuraton: Required  
Cipher Suite: AES-CCMP  
802.1x: Disable  
WPA Pre-shared Key Type: Hexadicmal or  
Alphanumeric  
Enter a WPA Pre-shared key  
802.1x WPA-WPA2  
Mixed Mode  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local or Disabled  
Yes  
Authentication: WPA-WPA2-mixed  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Required  
Cipher Suite: TKIP  
802.1x: Required  
Set 802.1x key refresh and reauthentication rates  
WPA-WPA2 Mixed  
Interface Detail Settings:  
Local or Disabled  
No  
Mode Pre-Shared Key  
Authentication: WPA-WPA2-PSK-mixed  
Encryption: Enable  
WPA Configuration: Required  
Cipher Suite: TKIP  
802.1x: Disable  
WPA Pre-shared Key Type: Hexadicmal or  
Alphanumeric  
Enter a WPA Pre-shared key  
a. The configuration summary does not include the set up for MAC authentication or RADIUS server .  
b. The configuration of RADIUS MAC authentication together with 802.1x WPA or WPA Pre-shared Key  
is not supported.  
c. RADIUS server required only when RADIUS MAC authentication is configured.  
d. RADIUS server required only when RADIUS MAC authentication is configured.  
NOTE  
If you choose to configure RADIUS MAC authentication together with 802.1X, the RADIUS MAC  
address authentication occurs prior to 802.1X authentication. Only when RADIUS MAC  
authentication succeeds is 802.1X authentication performed. When RADIUS MAC authentication  
fails, 802.1X authentication is not performed.  
4.6.2.1  
Enabling the VAPs  
Before enabling the Virtual Access Point (VAP) radio interfaces, first configure all  
of the relevant radio settings (see “Radio Settings G (802.11g)” on page 85.)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
After you have configured the radio settings, select Security under Radio G, set an  
SSID to identify the wireless network service provided by each VAP you want to  
use, and then click Apply to save your settings.  
Before enabling the radio service for any VAP, first configure the WEP, WPA, and  
802.1X security settings described in the following sections. After you have  
finished configuring the security settings, return to the main Security page shown  
below, start the required VAP interfaces by clicking the Enable checkbox, and  
then click Apply.  
Figure 4-23: Security  
Enable – Enables radio communications on the VAP interface. (Default: Disabled)  
NOTE  
You must first enable VAP interface 0 before you can enable other VAP interfaces.  
SSID – The name of the basic service set provided by a VAP interface. Clients that  
want to connect to the network through the access point must set their SSID to  
the same as that of an access point VAP interface. (Default: VAP_TEST_11A #  
(0-3); Range: 1-32 characters)  
4.6.2.2  
Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP)  
WEP provides a basic level of security, preventing unauthorized access to the  
network, and encrypting data transmitted between wireless clients and the access  
point. WEP uses static shared keys (fixed-length hexadecimal or alphanumeric  
strings) that are manually distributed to all clients that want to use the network.  
108  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Radio Interface  
WEP is the security protocol initially specified in the IEEE 802.11 standard for  
wireless communications. Unfortunately, WEP has been found to be seriously  
flawed and cannot be recommended for a high level of network security. For more  
robust wireless security, the access point provides WiFi Protected Access (WPA)  
for improved data encryption and user authentication.  
Setting up shared keys enables the basic IEEE 802.11 Wired Equivalent Privacy  
(WEP) on the access point to prevent unauthorized access to the network.  
If you choose to use WEP shared keys instead of an open system, be sure to define  
at least one static WEP key for user authentication and data encryption. Also, be  
sure that the WEP shared keys are the same for each client in the wireless  
network.  
NOTE  
All clients share the same keys, which are used for user authentication and data encryption. Up to  
four keys can be specified. These four keys are used for all VAP interfaces on the same radio.  
To set up WEP shared keys, click Radio Settings.  
Figure 4-24: WEP Shared Keys  
Key Type – Select the preferred method of entering WEP encryption keys on the  
access point and enter up to four keys:  
Hexadecimal: Enter keys as 10 hexadecimal digits (0-9 and A-F) for 64 bit  
keys, 26 hexadecimal digits for 128 bit keys, or 32 hexadecimal digits for 152  
bit keys (802.11g radio only). This is the default setting.  
Alphanumeric: Enter keys as 5 alphanumeric characters for 64 bit keys, 13  
alphanumeric characters for 128 bit keys, or 16 alphanumeric characters for  
152 bit keys.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Key Number – Selects the key number to use for encryption for each VAP interface.  
If the clients have all four keys configured to the same values, you can change the  
encryption key to any of the four settings without having to update the client keys.  
(Default: Key 1)  
Shared Key Setup – Select 64 Bit, 128 Bit, or 152 Bit key length. Note that the  
same size of encryption key must be supported on all wireless clients. (Default:  
None)  
NOTE  
Key index and type must match that configured on the clients.  
In a mixed-mode environment with clients using static WEP keys and WPA, select WEP transmit  
key index 2, 3, or 4. The access point uses transmit key index 1 for the generation of dynamic  
keys.  
To enable WEP shared keys for a VAP interface, click Security. Then, select the  
VAP interface that will use WEP keys by clicking More, and configure the  
Authentication Type Setup and Encryption fields.  
Figure 4-25: Security - Shared Keys  
Authentication Type Setup – Sets the access point to communicate as an open  
system that accepts network access attempts from any client, or with clients  
using pre-configured static shared keys. (Default: Open System)  
Open System: If you don’t set up any other security mechanism on the access  
point, the network has no protection and is open to all users. This is the  
default setting.  
110  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Radio Interface  
Shared Key: Sets the access point to use WEP shared keys. If this option is  
selected, you must configure at least one key on the access point and all  
clients.  
NOTE  
To use 802.1X on wireless clients requires a network card driver and 802.1X client software that  
supports the EAP authentication type that you want to use. Windows 2000 SP3 or later and  
Windows XP provide 802.1X client support. Windows XP also provides native WPA support. Other  
systems require additional client software to support 802.1X and WPA.  
Encryption – Enable or disable the access point to use data encryption (WEP,  
TKIP, or AES). If this option is selected when using static WEP keys, you must  
configure at least one key on the access point and all clients. (Default: Disabled)  
NOTE  
You must enable data encryption through the web or CLI in order to enable all types of encryption  
(WEP, TKIP, or AES) in the AP.  
4.6.2.2.1  
CLI Commands for WEP Shared Key Security  
To enable WEP shared key security for the 802.11g interface, use the interface  
wireless g command from the CLI configuration mode to access the interface  
mode for the 802.11g radio. First use the key command to define up to four WEP  
keys that can be used for all VAP interfaces on the radio. Then use the vap  
command to access each VAP interface to configure other security settings.  
From the VAP interface configuration mode, use the auth command to enable  
WEP shared-key authentication, which enables encryption automatically. Then  
set one key as the transmit key for the VAP interface using the transmit-key  
command. To view the current security settings, use the show interface wireless  
g [0-3] command from the Exec mode.  
4.6.2.2.2  
CLI Commands for WEP over 802.1X Security  
Use the vap command to access each VAP interface to configure the security  
settings. First set 802.1X to required using the 802.1x command and set the  
802.1X key refresh rates. Then, use the auth command to select open system  
authentication and the encryption command to enable data encryption. To view  
the current security settings, use the show interface wireless g [0-3] command  
(not shown in example).  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#vap 0  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X required  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X session-timeout 300  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#auth open-system  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#encryption  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
4.6.2.3  
WiFi Protected Access (WPA)  
WPA employs a combination of several technologies to provide an enhanced  
security solution for 802.11 wireless networks.  
The access point supports the following WPA components and features:  
IEEE 802.1X and the Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP): WPA employs  
802.1X as its basic framework for user authentication and dynamic key  
management. The 802.1X client and RADIUS server should use an appropriate  
EAP type—such as EAP-TLS (Transport Layer Security), EAP-TTLS (Tunneled  
TLS), or PEAP (Protected EAP)—for strongest authentication. Working together,  
these protocols provide “mutual authentication” between a client, the access  
point, and a RADIUS server that prevents users from accidentally joining a rogue  
network. Only when a RADIUS server has authenticated a user’s credentials will  
encryption keys be sent to the access point and client.  
NOTE  
To implement WPA on wireless clients requires a WPA-enabled network card driver and 802.1X  
client software that supports the EAP authentication type that you want to use. Windows XP  
provides native WPA support, other systems require additional software.  
Temporal Key Integrity Protocol (TKIP): WPA specifies TKIP as the data  
encryption method to replace WEP. TKIP avoids the problems of WEP static keys  
by dynamically changing data encryption keys. Basically, TKIP starts with a  
master (temporal) key for each user session and then mathematically generates  
other keys to encrypt each data packet. TKIP provides further data encryption  
enhancements by including a message integrity check for each packet and a  
re-keying mechanism, which periodically changes the master key.  
WPA Pre-Shared Key Mode (WPA-PSK, WPA2-PSK): For enterprise deployment,  
WPA requires a RADIUS authentication server to be configured on the wired  
network. However, for small office networks that may not have the resources to  
configure and maintain a RADIUS server, WPA provides a simple operating mode  
that uses just a pre-shared password for network access. The Pre-Shared Key  
mode uses a common password for user authentication that is manually entered  
on the access point and all wireless clients. The PSK mode uses the same TKIP  
112  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Radio Interface  
packet encryption and key management as WPA in the enterprise, providing a  
robust and manageable alternative for small networks.  
Mixed WPA and WEP Client Support: WPA enables the access point to indicate  
its supported encryption and authentication mechanisms to clients using its  
beacon signal. WPA-compatible clients can likewise respond to indicate their WPA  
support. This enables the access point to determine which clients are using WPA  
security and which are using legacy WEP. The access point uses TKIP unicast  
data encryption keys for WPA clients and WEP unicast keys for WEP clients. The  
global encryption key for multicast and broadcast traffic must be the same for all  
clients, therefore it restricts encryption to a WEP key.  
When access is opened to both WPA and WEP clients, no authentication is  
provided for the WEP clients through shared keys. To support authentication for  
WEP clients in this mixed mode configuration, you can use either MAC  
authentication or 802.1X authentication.  
WPA2 – WPA was introduced as an interim solution for the vulnerability of WEP  
pending the ratification of the IEEE 802.11i wireless security standard. In effect,  
the WPA security features are a subset of the 802.11i standard. WPA2 includes  
the now ratified 802.11i standard, but also offers backward compatibility with  
WPA. Therefore, WPA2 includes the same 802.1X and PSK modes of operation and  
support for TKIP encryption. The main differences and enhancements in WPA2  
can be summarized as follows:  
Advanced Encryption Standard (AES): WPA2 uses AES Counter-Mode  
encryption with Cipher Block Chaining Message Authentication Code  
(CBC-MAC) for message integrity. The AES Counter-Mode/CBCMAC Protocol  
(AES-CCMP) provides extremely robust data confidentiality using a 128-bit  
key. The AES-CCMP encryption cipher is specified as a standard requirement  
for WPA2. However, the computational intensive operations of AES-CCMP  
requires hardware support on client devices. Therefore to implement WPA2 in  
the network, wireless clients must be upgraded to WPA2-compliant hardware.  
WPA2 Mixed-Mode: WPA2 defines a transitional mode of operation for  
networks moving from WPA security to WPA2. WPA2 Mixed Mode allows both  
WPA and WPA2 clients to associate to a common SSID interface. In mixed  
mode, the unicast encryption cipher (TKIP or AES-CCMP) is negotiated for  
each client. The access point advertises its supported encryption ciphers in  
beacon frames and probe responses. WPA and WPA2 clients select the cipher  
they support and return the choice in the association request to the access  
point. For mixed-mode operation, the cipher used for broadcast frames is  
always TKIP. WEP encryption is not allowed.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Key Caching: WPA2 provides fast roaming for authenticated clients by  
retaining keys and other security information in a cache, so that if a client  
roams away from an access point and then returns, re-authentication is not  
required. When a WPA2 client is first authenticated, it receives a Pairwise  
Master Key (PMK) that is used to generate other keys for unicast data  
encryption. This key and other client information form a Security Association  
that the access point names and holds in a cache.  
Preauthentication: Each time a client roams to another access point it has to  
be fully re-authenticated. This authentication process is time consuming and  
can disrupt applications running over the network. WPA2 includes a  
mechanism, known as pre-authentication, that allows clients to roam to a new  
access point and be quickly associated. The first time a client is authenticated  
to a wireless network it has to be fully authenticated. When the client is about  
to roam to another access point in the network, the access point sends  
pre-authentication messages to the new access point that include the client’s  
security association information. Then when the client sends an association  
request to the new access point, the client is known to be already  
authenticated, so it proceeds directly to key exchange and association.  
To configure WPA, click Security, select one of the VAP interfaces by clicking  
More. Select one of the WPA options in the Authentication Setup table, and then  
configure the parameters displayed beneath the table.  
114  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Interface  
Figure 4-26: Security - WPA Configuration  
The WPA configuration parameters are described below:  
Encryption – You must enable data encryption in order to enable all types of  
encryption (WEP, TKIP, or AES) in the access point.  
Pre-Authentication – When using WPA2 over 802.1X, pre-authentication can be  
enabled, which allows clients to roam to a new access point and be quickly  
associated without performing full 802.1X authentication. (Default: Disabled)  
Authentication Setup – To use WPA or WPA2, set the access point to one of the  
following options. If a WPA/WPA2 mode that operates over 802.1X is selected  
(WPA, WPA2, or WPA-WPA2-mixed), the 802.1X settings and RADIUS server  
details need to be configured. Be sure you have also configured a RADIUS server  
on the network before enabling authentication. If a WPA/WPA2 Pre-shared Key  
mode is selected (WPA-PSK, WPA2-PSK, or WPA-WPA2 PSK-Mixed), be sure to  
specify the key string.  
WPA: Clients using WPA over 802.1X are accepted for authentication.  
WPA-PSK: Clients using WPA with a Pre-shared Key are accepted for  
authentication.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
WPA2: Clients using WPA2 over 802.1X are accepted for authentication.  
WPA2-PSK: Clients using WPA2 with a Pre-shared Key are accepted for  
authentication.  
WPA-WPA2-mixed: Clients using WPA or WPA2 over 802.1X are accepted for  
authentication.  
WPA-WPA2-PSK-mixed: Clients using WPA or WPA2 with a Pre-shared Key are  
accepted for authentication.  
WPA Configuration – Each VAP interface can be configured to allow only  
WPA-enabled clients to access the network (Required), or to allow access to both  
WPA and WEP clients (Supported). (Default: Required)  
Cipher Suite – Selects an encryption method for the global key used for multicast  
and broadcast traffic, which is supported by all wireless clients.  
WEP: WEP is used as the multicast encryption cipher. You should select WEP  
only when both WPA and WEP clients are supported.  
TKIP: TKIP is used as the multicast encryption cipher.  
AES-CCMP: AES-CCMP is used as the multicast encryption cipher. AES-CCMP  
is the standard encryption cipher required for WPA2.  
WPA Pre-Shared Key Type – If the WPA or WPA2 pre-shared-key mode is used, all  
wireless clients must be configured with the same key to communicate with the  
AP.  
Hexadecimal – Enter a key as a string of 64 hexadecimal numbers.  
Alphanumeric – Enter a key as an easy-to-remember form of letters and  
numbers. The string must be from 8 to 63 characters, which can include  
spaces.  
116  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Radio Interface  
The configuration settings for WPA are summarized in Table 4-8:  
Table 4-8: WPA Configuration Settings  
WPA and WPA2 pre-shared key only  
WPA and WPA2 over 802.1X  
Encryption: Enabled  
Encryption: Enabled  
Authentication Setup: WPA-PSK, WPA2-PSK, or  
WPA-WPA2-mixed  
Authentication Setup: WPA, WPA2,  
WPA-WPA2-mixed  
Cipher Suite: WEP/TKIP/AES-CCMP  
WPA Pre-shared Key Type: Hex/ASCII  
Cipher Suite: WEP/TKIP/AES-CCMP  
(requires RADIUS server to be specified)  
1: You must enable data encryption in order to enable all types of encryption in the access point.  
2: Select TKIP when any WPA clients do not support AES. Select AES only if all clients support AES.  
4.6.2.3.1  
CLI Commands for WPA Using Pre-shared Key Security  
From the VAP interface configuration mode, use the auth wpa-psk required  
command to enable WPA Pre-shared Key security. To enter a key value, use the  
wpa-pre-shared-key command to specify a hexadecimal or alphanumeric key. To  
view the current security settings, use the show interface wireless a [0-3] or  
show interface wireless g [0-3] command (not shown in example).  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface wireless g  
Enter Wireless configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#vap 0  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#wpa-pre-shared-key  
passphrase-key agoodsecret  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#auth wpa-psk required  
Data Encryption is set to Enabled.  
WPA2 Clients Mode is set to Disabled.  
WPA Clients Mode is set to Required.  
WPA Multicast Cipher is set to TKIP.  
WPA Unicast Cipher can accept TKIP only.  
WPA Authentication is set to Pre-Shared Key.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
4.6.2.3.2  
CLI Commands for WPA Over 802.1X Security  
From the VAP interface configuration mode, use the auth wpa required command  
to select WPA over 802.1X security. Then set the 802.1X key refresh rates. To view  
the current security settings, use the show interface wireless a [0-3] or show  
interface wireless g [0-3] command (not shown in example).  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface wireless g  
Enter Wireless configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#vap 0  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#auth wpa required  
Data Encryption is set to Enabled.  
WPA2 Clients mode is set to Disabled.  
WPA Clients Mode is set to Required.  
WPA Multicast Cipher is set to TKIP.  
WPA Unicast Cipher can accept TKIP only.  
WPA Authentication is set to 802.1X Required.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X broadcast-key-refresh-rate 5  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X  
session-key-refresh-rate 5  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X session-timeout 300  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
4.6.2.4  
Configuring 802.1X  
IEEE 802.1X is a standard framework for network access control that uses a  
central RADIUS server for user authentication. This control feature prevents  
unauthorized access to the network by requiring an 802.1X client application to  
submit user credentials for authentication. The 802.1X standard uses the  
Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP) to pass user credentials (either digital  
certificates, user names and passwords, or other) from the client to the RADIUS  
server. Client authentication is then verified on the RADIUS server before the  
access point grants client access to the network.  
The 802.1X EAP packets are also used to pass dynamic unicast session keys and  
static broadcast keys to wireless clients. Session keys are unique to each client  
and are used to encrypt and correlate traffic passing between a specific client and  
the access point. You can also enable broadcast key rotation, so the access point  
provides a dynamic broadcast key and changes it at a specified interval.  
Open the Security page, and click More for one of the VAP interfaces.  
Figure 4-27: 802.1X Configuration  
118  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Radio Interface  
You can enable 802.1X as optionally supported or as required to enhance the  
security of the wireless network. (Default: Disable)  
Disable: The AP does not support 802.1X authentication for any wireless  
client. After successful wireless association with the access point, each client  
is allowed to access the network.  
Supported: The access point supports 802.1X authentication only for clients  
initiating the 802.1X authentication process (i.e., the access point does not  
initiate 802.1X authentication). For clients initiating 802.1X, only those  
successfully authenticated are allowed to access the network. For those clients  
not initiating 802.1X, access to the network is allowed after successful  
wireless association with the access point. The 802.1X supported mode allows  
access for clients not using WPA or WPA2 security.  
Required: The access point enforces 802.1X authentication for all associated  
wireless clients. If 802.1X authentication is not initiated by a client, the AP will  
initiate authentication. Only those clients successfully authenticated with  
802.1X are allowed to access the network.  
NOTE  
If 802.1X is enabled on the access point, then RADIUS setup must be completed (see “RADIUS”  
4.6.2.4.1  
CLI Commands for 802.1X Authentication  
Use the 802.1X supported command from the VAP interface mode to enable  
802.1X authentication. Set the session and broadcast key refresh rate, and the  
re-authentication timeout. To display the current settings, use the show  
interface wireless command from the Exec mode (not shown in the example).  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X supported  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X broadcast-key-refresh-rate 5  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X session-key-refresh-rate 5  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#802.1X session-timeout 300  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.7  
Status Information  
The Status page includes information on the following items:  
Table 4-9: Status Page Information  
Description  
Menu  
Page  
AP Status  
Displays configuration settings for the basic system and the wireless  
interface  
Station Status  
Event Logs  
Shows the wireless clients currently associated with the access point  
Shows log messages stored in memory  
4.7.1 Access Point Status  
The AP Status window displays basic system configuration settings, as well as the  
settings for the wireless interface.  
Figure 4-28: AP Status  
120  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Status Information  
AP System Configuration – The AP System Configuration table displays the basic  
system configuration settings:  
System Up Time: Length of time the management agent has been up.  
Ethernet MAC: The physical layer address for the Ethernet port.  
Radio G MAC: The physical layer address for the 802.11b/g interface. System  
Name: Name assigned to this system.  
System Contact: Administrator responsible for the system.  
IP Address: IP address of the management interface for this device.  
IP Default Gateway: IP address of the gateway router between this device and  
management stations that exist on other network segments.  
HTTP Server: Shows if management access via HTTP is enabled.  
HTTP Server Port: Shows the TCP port used by the HTTP interface.  
Software Version: Shows the software version number.  
Bootrom Version: Show the bootrom version number.  
Hardware Version: Shows the hardware version number.  
AP Wireless Configuration – The AP Wireless Configuration tables display the  
radio and VAP interface settings listed below.  
SSID: The service set identifier for the VAP interface.  
Radio Channel: The radio channel through which the access point  
communicates with wireless clients.  
Encryption: The key size used for data encryption.  
Authentication Type: Shows the type of authentication used.  
802.1X: Shows if IEEE 802.1X access control for wireless clients is enabled.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
4.7.1.0.1  
CLI Commands for Displaying System Settings  
To view the current access point system settings, use the show system command  
from the Exec mode. To view the current radio interface settings, use the show  
interface wireless a or show interface wireless g command (see page 227).  
Enterprise AP#show system  
System Information  
==========================================================  
Serial Number  
System Up time  
System Name  
: A123456789  
: 0 days, 4 hours, 33 minutes, 29 seconds  
: Enterprise wireless gP  
System Location  
System Contact  
:
:
System Country Code : US - UNITED STATES  
MAC Address  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
VLAN State  
: 00-30-F1-F0-9A-9C  
: 192.168.1.1  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 0.0.0.0  
: DISABLED  
Management VLAN ID(AP): 1  
IAPP State  
: ENABLED  
DHCP Client  
HTTP Server  
: ENABLED  
: ENABLED  
: 80  
: ENABLED  
: 443  
: 802.11g only  
: v2.1.6  
: v4.3.3.8b02  
: ENABLED  
: 22  
: ENABLED  
: DISABLED  
: DISABLED  
HTTP Server Port  
HTTPS Server  
HTTPS Server Port  
Slot Status  
Boot Rom Version  
Software Version  
SSH Server  
SSH Server Port  
Telnet Server  
WEB Redirect  
DHCP Relay  
==========================================================  
Enterprise AP  
4.7.2 Station Status  
The Station Status window shows the wireless clients currently associated with  
the access point.  
122  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Status Information  
Figure 4-29: Station Status  
The Station Configuration page displays basic connection information for all  
associated stations as described below. This page is automatically refreshed every  
five seconds.  
Station Address: The MAC address of the wireless client.  
Authenticated: Shows if the station has been authenticated. The two basic  
methods of authentication supported for 802.11 wireless networks are “open  
system” and “shared key.” Open-system authentication accepts any client  
attempting to connect to the access point without verifying its identity. The  
shared-key approach uses Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) to verify client  
identity by distributing a shared key to stations before attempting  
authentication.  
Associated: Shows if the station has been successfully associated with the  
access point. Once authentication is completed, stations can associate with  
the current access point, or reassociate with a new access point. The  
association procedure allows the wireless system to track the location of each  
mobile client, and ensure that frames destined for each client are forwarded to  
the appropriate access point.  
Forwarding Allowed: Shows if the station has passed 802.1X authentication  
and is now allowed to forward traffic to the access point.  
Key Type – Displays one of the following:  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
WEP Disabled – The client is not using Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP)  
encryption keys.  
Dynamic – The client is using WiFi Protected Access (802.1X or pre-shared  
key mode) or using 802.1X authentication with dynamic keying.  
Static – The client is using static WEP keys for encryption.  
4.7.2.0.1  
CLI Commands for Displaying Station Status  
To view status of clients currently associated with the access point, use the show  
station command from the Exec mode.  
Enterprise AP#show station  
Station Table Information  
===========================================================  
if-wireless G VAP [0] :  
802.11g Channel : Auto  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
if-wireless G VAP [1] :  
802.11g Channel : Auto  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
....  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
if-wireless G VAP [3] :  
802.11g Channel : Auto  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
===========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.7.3 Event Logs  
The Event Logs window shows the log messages generated by the AP and stored in  
memory.  
124  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Status Information  
Figure 4-30: Event Log  
The Event Logs table displays the following information:  
Log Time: The time the log message was generated.  
Event Level: The logging level associated with this message. For a description  
of the various levels, see “logging level” on page 74.  
Event Message: The content of the log message.  
Error Messages : An example of a logged error message is: “Station Failed to  
authenticate (unsupported algorithm).”  
This message may be caused by any of the following conditions:  
AP was set to Open Authentication, but a client sent an authentication request  
frame with a Shared key.  
AP was set to Shared Key Authentication, but a client sent an authentication  
frame for Open System.  
WEP keys do not match: When the AP uses Shared Key Authentication, but the  
key used by client and access point are not the same, the frame will be  
decrypted incorrectly, using the wrong algorithm and sequence number.  
4.7.3.0.1  
CLI Commands for Displaying the Logging Status  
From the global configuration mode, use the show logging command.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 - System Configuration  
Enterprise AP#show logging  
Logging Information  
============================================  
Syslog State  
Logging Console State  
Logging Level  
Logging Facility Type  
Servers  
: Enabled  
: Enabled  
: Alert  
: 16  
1: 192.168.1.19, UDP Port: 514, State: Enabled  
2: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
3: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
4: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
=============================================  
Enterprise AP#  
4.7.3.0.2  
CLI Commands for Displaying Event Logs  
To view the access point log entries, use the show event-log command from the  
Exec mode. To clear all log entries from the access point, use the logging clear  
command from the Global Configuration mode.  
Enterprise AP#show event-log  
Mar 09 11:57:55 Information: 802.11g:11g Radio Interface Enabled  
Mar 09 11:57:55 Information: 802.11g:Radio channel updated to 8  
Mar 09 11:57:34 Information: 802.11g:11g Radio Interface Enabled  
Mar 09 11:57:18 Information: 802.11g:11g Radio Interface Enabled  
Mar 09 11:55:52 Information: SSH task: Set SSH server port to 22  
Mar 09 11:55:52 Information: SSH task: Enable SSH server.  
Mar 09 11:55:52 Information: Enable Telnet.  
Press <n> next. <p> previous. <a> abort. <y> continue to end :  
Enterprise AP#configure  
Enter configuration commands, one per line. End with CTRL/Z  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging clear  
Enterprise AP#  
126  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Command Line Interface  
5.1  
Using the Command Line Interface  
5.1.1 Accessing the CLI  
When accessing the management interface over a direct connection to the console  
port, or via a Telnet connection, the Access Point (AP) unit can be managed by  
entering command keywords and parameters at the prompt. Using AP’s  
command-line interface (CLI) is very similar to entering commands on a UNIX  
system.  
5.1.2 Console Connection  
2
To access the Wi through the console port:  
1
At the console prompt, enter the user name and password. (The default user  
name is admin and the default password is null.) When the user name is  
entered, the CLI displays the Enterprise AP#prompt.  
2
3
Enter the necessary commands to complete your desired tasks.  
When finished, exit the session with the “exit” command.  
After connecting to the system through the console port, the login screen is  
displayed:  
Username: admin  
Password:  
Enterprise AP#  
CAUTION  
Command examples shown later in this chapter abbreviate the console prompt to “AP” for  
simplicity.  
5.1.3 Telnet Connection  
Telnet operates over the IP transport protocol. In this environment, your  
management station and any network device you want to manage over the  
network must have a valid IP address. Valid IP addresses consist of four numbers,  
0 to 255, separated by periods. Each address consists of a network portion and  
host portion. For example, if the AP cannot acquire an IP address from a DHCP  
server, the default IP address used by the AP, 192.168.1.1, consists of a network  
portion (192.168.1) and a host portion (1).  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
To access the AP through a Telnet session, you must first set the IP address for  
the AP, and set the default gateway if you are managing the AP from a different IP  
subnet. For example:  
Enterprise AP#configure  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip address 10.1.0.1 255.255.255.0 10.1.0.254  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
If your corporate network is connected to another network outside your office or to  
the Internet, you need to apply for a registered IP address. However, if you are  
attached to an isolated network, then you can use any IP address that matches  
the network segment to which you are attached.  
After you have configured the AP with an IP address, you can open a Telnet  
session.  
To open an Telnet session:  
1
2
From the remote host, enter the Telnet command and the IP address of the  
device you want to access.  
At the prompt, enter the user name and system password. The CLI will display  
the Enterprise AP#prompt to show that you are using executive access mode  
(i.e., Exec).  
3
4
Enter the necessary commands to complete your desired tasks.  
When finished, exit the session with the “quit” or “exit” command.  
After entering the Telnet command, the login screen is displayed:  
Username: admin  
Password:  
Enterprise AP#  
CAUTION  
You can open up to four sessions to the device via Telnet.  
130  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entering Commands  
5.2  
Entering Commands  
This section describes how to enter CLI commands.  
5.2.1 Keywords and Arguments  
A CLI command is a series of keywords and arguments. Keywords identify a  
command, and arguments specify configuration parameters. For example, in the  
command “show interfaces ethernet,” show and interfaces are keywords, and  
ethernet is an argument that specifies the interface type.  
You can enter commands as follows:  
To enter a simple command, enter the command keyword.  
To enter commands that require parameters, enter the required parameters  
after the command keyword. For example, to set a password for the  
administrator, enter:  
Enterprise AP(config)#username smith  
5.2.2 Minimum Abbreviation  
The CLI accepts a minimum number of characters that uniquely identify a  
command. For example, the command “configure” can be entered as con. If an  
entry is ambiguous, the system will prompt for further input.  
5.2.3 Command Completion  
If you terminate input with a Tab key, the CLI will print the remaining characters  
of a partial keyword up to the point of ambiguity. In the “configure” example,  
typing con followed by a tab will result in printing the command up to  
configure.”  
5.2.4 Getting Help on Commands  
You can display a brief description of the help system by entering the help  
command. You can also display command syntax by following a command with  
the “?” character to list keywords or parameters.  
5.2.4.1  
Showing Commands  
If you enter a “?” at the command prompt, the system will display the first level of  
keywords for the current configuration mode (Exec, Global Configuration, or  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Interface). You can also display a list of valid keywords for a specific command.  
For example, the command “show ?” displays a list of possible show commands:  
Enterprise AP#show ?  
APmanagement Show management AP information.  
authentication Show Authentication parameters  
bootfile  
bridge  
Show bootfile name  
Show bridge  
config  
System snapshot for tech support  
Show DHCP Relay Configuration  
Show event log on console  
Show filters  
Show hardware version  
Display the session history  
Show interface information  
TTY line information  
dhcp-relay  
event-log  
filters  
hardware  
history  
interface  
line  
link-integrity Show link integrity information  
logging  
radius  
Show the logging buffers  
Show radius server  
rogue-ap  
snmp  
sntp  
station  
system  
Show Rogue ap Stations  
Show snmp configuration  
Show sntp configuration  
Show 802.11 station table  
Show system information  
Show system version  
version  
Enterprise AP#show  
The command “show interface ?” will display the following information:  
Enterprise AP#show interface ?  
ethernet Show Ethernet interface  
wireless Show wireless interface  
<cr>  
Enterprise AP#show interface  
5.2.5 Partial Keyword Lookup  
If you terminate a partial keyword with a question mark, alternatives that match  
the initial letters are provided. (Remember not to leave a space between the  
command and question mark.) For example “s?” shows all the keywords starting  
with “s.”  
Enterprise AP#show s?  
snmp  
sntp  
station system  
Enterprise AP#show s  
5.2.6 Negating the Effect of Commands  
For many configuration commands you can enter the prefix keyword “no” to  
cancel the effect of a command or reset the configuration to the default value. For  
example, the logging command will log system messages to a host server. To  
132  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Entering Commands  
disable logging, specify the no logging command. This guide describes the  
negation effect for all applicable commands.  
5.2.7 Using Command History  
The CLI maintains a history of commands that have been entered. You can scroll  
back through the history of commands by pressing the up arrow key. Any  
command displayed in the history list can be executed again, or first modified and  
then executed.  
Using the show history command displays a longer list of recently executed  
commands.  
5.2.8 Understanding Command Modes  
The command set is divided into Exec and Configuration classes. Exec commands  
generally display information on system status or clear statistical counters.  
Configuration commands, on the other hand, modify interface parameters or  
enable certain functions. These classes are further divided into different modes.  
Available commands depend on the selected mode. You can always enter a  
question mark “?” at the prompt to display a list of the commands available for  
the current mode. The command classes and associated modes are displayed in  
Table 5-1: Command Classes and Associated Modes  
Class  
Mode  
Exec  
Privileged  
Configuration  
Global  
Interface-ethernet  
Interface-wireless  
Interface-wireless-vap  
5.2.9 Exec Commands  
When you open a new console session on an AP, the system enters Exec command  
mode. Only a limited number of the commands are available in this mode. You  
can access all other commands only from the configuration mode. To access Exec  
mode, open a new console session with the user name admin. The command  
prompt displays as Enterprise AP#for Exec mode.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Username: admin  
Password: [system login password]  
Enterprise AP#  
5.2.10 Configuration Commands  
Configuration commands are used to modify AP settings. These commands modify  
the running configuration and are saved in memory.  
The configuration commands are organized into four different modes:  
Global Configuration (GC) - These commands modify the system level  
configuration, and include commands such as username and password.  
Interface-Ethernet Configuration (IC-E) - These commands modify the  
Ethernet port configuration, and include command such as dns and ip.  
Interface-Wireless Configuration (IC-W) - These commands modify the wireless  
port configuration of global parameters for the radio, and include commands  
such as channel and transmit-power.  
Interface-Wireless Virtual Access Point Configuration (IC-W-VAP) - These  
commands modify the wireless port configuration for each VAP, and include  
commands such as ssid and authentication.  
To enter the Global Configuration mode, enter the command configure in Exec  
mode. The system prompt will change to “Enterprise AP(config)#” which gives you  
access privilege to all Global Configuration commands.  
Enterprise AP#configure  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
To enter Interface mode, you must enter the “interface ethernet,” or “interface  
wireless a,” or “interface wireless g” command while in Global Configuration  
mode. The system prompt will change to “Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#,” or  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless)” indicating that you have access privileges to the  
associated commands. You can use the end command to return to the Exec mode.  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.2.11 Command Line Processing  
Commands are not case sensitive. You can abbreviate commands and parameters  
as long as they contain enough letters to differentiate them from any other  
134  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Entering Commands  
currently available commands or parameters. You can use the Tab key to  
complete partial commands, or enter a partial command followed by the “?”  
character to display a list of possible matches. You can also use the following  
editing keystrokes for command-line processing:  
Table 5-2: Keystroke Commands  
Keystroke  
Ctrl-A  
Ctrl-B  
Ctrl-C  
Ctrl-E  
Ctrl-F  
Function  
Shifts cursor to start of command line.  
Shifts cursor to the left one character.  
Terminates a task and displays the command prompt.  
Shifts cursor to end of command line.  
Shifts cursor to the right one character.  
Deletes from cursor to the end of the command line.  
Repeats current command line on a new line.  
Enters the next command line in the history buffer.  
Shows the last command.  
Ctrl-K  
Ctrl-L  
Ctrl-N  
Ctrl-P  
Ctrl-R  
Ctrl-U  
Ctrl-W  
Esc-B  
Esc-D  
Esc-F  
Repeats current command line on a new line.  
Deletes the entire line.  
Deletes the last word typed.  
Moves the cursor backward one word.  
Deletes from the cursor to the end of the word.  
Moves the cursor forward one word.  
Erases a mistake when entering a command.  
Delete key or  
backspace key  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.3  
Command Groups  
The system commands can be broken down into the functional groups shown  
below.  
Table 5-3: Command Group  
Command Group  
Description  
Page  
General  
Basic commands for entering configuration mode, restarting the system, or  
quitting the CLI  
System Management  
Controls user name, password, web browser management options, and a  
variety of other system information  
System Logging  
System Clock  
DHCP Relay  
SNMP  
Configures system logging parameters  
Configures SNTP and system clock settings  
Configures the AP to send DHCP requests from clients to specified servers  
Configures community access strings and trap managers  
Manages code image or AP configuration files  
Configures the RADIUS client used with 802.1X authentication  
Configures 802.1X authentication  
Flash/File  
RADIUS  
802.1X Authentication  
MAC Address  
Authentication  
Configures MAC address authentication  
Filtering  
Filters communications between wireless clients, controls access to the  
management interface from wireless clients, and filters traffic using specific  
Ethernet protocol types  
WDS Bridge  
Spanning Tree  
Ethernet Interface  
Wireless Interface  
Wireless Security  
Rogue AP Detection  
Link Integrity  
IAPP  
Not applicable for the current release  
Not applicable for the current release  
Configures connection parameters for the Ethernet interface  
Configures radio interface settings  
Configures radio interface security and encryption settings  
Configures settings for the detection of rogue APs in the network  
Configures a link check to a host device on the wired network  
Enables roaming between multi-vendor APs  
Configures VLAN membership  
VLANs  
WMM  
Configures WMM quality of service parameters  
136  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Command Groups  
The access mode shown in the following tables is indicated by these abbreviations:  
Exec (Executive Mode), GC (Global Configuration), IC-E (Interface-Ethernet  
Configuration), IC-W (Interface-Wireless Configuration), and IC-W-VAP  
(Interface-Wireless VAP Configuration).  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.4  
General Commands  
Table 5-4: General Commands  
Command  
configure  
end  
Function  
Mode  
Exec  
GC, IC  
any  
Page  
Activates global configuration mode  
Returns to previous configuration mode  
exit  
Returns to the previous configuration mode, or exits the CLI  
Sends ICMP echo request packets to another node on the network  
Restarts the system  
ping  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
reset  
show history  
show line  
Shows the command history buffer  
Shows the configuration settings for the console port  
138  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
General Commands  
5.4.1 configure  
This command activates Global Configuration mode. You must enter this mode to  
modify most of the settings on the AP. You must also enter Global Configuration  
mode prior to enabling the context modes for Interface Configuration. see “Using  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#configure  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.4.2 end  
This command returns to the previous configuration mode.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration, Interface Configuration  
Example  
This example shows how to return to the Configuration mode from the Interface  
Configuration mode:  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#end  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.4.3 exit  
This command returns to the Exec mode or exits the configuration program.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Any  
Example  
This example shows how to return to the Exec mode from the Interface  
Configuration mode, and then quit the CLI session:  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#exit  
Enterprise AP#exit  
CLI session with the Access Point is now closed  
Username:  
5.4.4 ping  
This command sends ICMP echo request packets to another node on the network.  
Syntax  
ping <host_name | ip_address>  
host_name - Alias of the host.  
ip_address - IP address of the host.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
• Use the ping command to see if another site on the network can be reached.  
• The following are some results of the ping command:  
- Normal response - The normal response occurs in one to ten seconds, depending on network  
traffic.  
- Destination does not respond - If the host does not respond, a “timeout” appears in ten  
seconds.  
- Destination unreachable - The gateway for this destination indicates that the destination is  
unreachable.  
- Network or host unreachable - The gateway found no corresponding entry in the route table.  
• Press <Esc> to stop pinging.  
140  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
General Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP#ping 10.1.0.19  
192.168.1.19 is alive  
Enterprise AP#  
5.4.5 reset  
This command restarts the system or restores the factory default settings.  
Syntax  
reset <board | configuration>  
board - Reboots the system.  
configuration - Resets the configuration settings to the factory defaults, and then reboots the  
system.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
When the system is restarted, it will always run the Power-On Self-Test.  
Example  
This example shows how to reset the system:  
Enterprise AP#reset board  
Reboot system now? <y/n>: y  
5.4.6 show history  
This command shows the contents of the command history buffer.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
• The history buffer size is fixed at 10 commands.  
• Use the up or down arrow keys to scroll through the commands in the history buffer.  
Example  
In this example, the show history command lists the contents of the command  
history buffer:  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Enterprise AP#show history  
config  
exit  
show history  
Enterprise AP#  
5.4.7 show line  
This command displays the console port’s configuration settings.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
The console port settings are fixed at the values shown below.  
Enterprise AP#show line  
Console Line Information  
======================================================  
databits : 8  
parity  
speed  
: none  
: 9600  
stop bits : 1  
======================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
142  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Management Commands  
5.5  
System Management Commands  
These commands are used to configure the user name, password, system logs,  
browser management options, clock settings, and a variety of other system  
information.  
Table 5-5: System Management Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
Page  
Country Setting  
country  
Sets the AP country code  
Exec  
Device Designation  
prompt  
Customizes the command line prompt  
Specifies the host name for the AP  
Sets the system contact string  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
system name  
snmp-server contact  
snmp-server location  
Management Access  
username  
Sets the system location string  
Configures the user name for management access  
Specifies the password for management access  
Enables the Secure Shell server  
GC  
password  
GC  
ip ssh-server enable  
ip ssh-server port  
ip telnet-server enable  
APmgmtIP  
IC-E  
IC-E  
IC-E  
GC  
Sets the Secure Shell port  
Enables the Telnet server  
Specifies an IP address or range of addresses allowed access to  
the management interface  
APmgmtUI  
Enables or disables SNMP, Telnet or web management access  
Shows the AP management configuration  
GC  
show APmanagement  
Web Server  
Exec  
ip http port  
Specifies the port to be used by the web browser interface  
Allows the AP to be monitored or configured from a browser  
Sets the timeout for the web browser interface  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
ip http server  
ip http session-timeout  
ip https port  
Specifies the UDP port number used for a secure HTTP  
connection to the AP’s Web interface  
ip https server  
System Status  
show system  
Enables the secure HTTP server on the AP  
GC  
Displays system information  
Exec  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Table 5-5: System Management Commands  
Function  
Command  
show version  
show config  
Mode  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
Page  
Displays version information for the system  
Displays detailed configuration information for the system  
Displays the AP’s hardware version  
show hardware  
5.5.1 country  
This command configures the AP’s country code, which identifies the country of  
operation and sets the authorized radio channels.  
Syntax  
country <country_code>  
country_code - A two character code that identifies the country of operation. See the following  
table for a full list of codes.  
Table 5-6: Country Codes  
Country  
Code Country  
Code  
Country  
Code  
Country  
Code  
Albania  
AL  
Dominican  
Republic  
DO  
Kuwait  
KW  
Romania  
RO  
Algeria  
DZ  
AR  
AM  
AU  
AT  
Ecuador  
Egypt  
EC  
EG  
EE  
FI  
Latvia  
LV  
Russia  
RU  
SA  
SG  
SK  
ES  
SE  
CH  
SY  
TW  
TH  
TT  
Argentina  
Armenia  
Australia  
Austria  
Lebanon  
Liechtenstein  
Lithuania  
Macao  
LB  
Saudi Arabia  
Singapore  
Slovak Republic  
Spain  
Estonia  
LI  
Finland  
LT  
France  
FR  
GE  
DE  
GR  
GT  
HN  
HK  
MO  
MK  
MY  
MT  
MX  
MC  
MA  
Azerbaijan  
Bahrain  
Belarus  
Belgium  
AZ  
BH  
BY  
BE  
Georgia  
Germany  
Greece  
Macedonia  
Malaysia  
Malta  
Sweden  
Switzerland  
Syria  
Guatemala  
Honduras  
Hong Kong  
Mexico  
Taiwan  
Monaco  
Morocco  
Thailand  
Belize  
BZ  
Trinidad &  
Tobago  
Bolivia  
Brazil  
BO  
BR  
BN  
Hungary  
Iceland  
India  
HU  
IS  
Netherlands  
New Zealand  
Norway  
NL  
NZ  
NO  
Tunisia  
Turkey  
Ukraine  
TN  
TR  
UA  
Brunei  
IN  
Darussalam  
144  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Management Commands  
Table 5-6: Country Codes  
Bulgaria  
BG  
Indonesia  
ID  
Qatar  
QA  
United Arab  
Emirates  
AE  
Canada  
Chile  
CA  
CL  
CN  
CO  
CR  
HR  
CY  
CZ  
Iran  
IR  
IE  
Oman  
OM  
PK  
PA  
PE  
PH  
PL  
United Kingdom  
United States  
Uruguay  
GB  
US  
UY  
UZ  
YE  
VE  
VN  
ZW  
Ireland  
Israel  
Pakistan  
Panama  
Peru  
China  
IL  
Colombia  
Costa Rica  
Croatia  
Cyprus  
Italy  
IT  
Uzbekistan  
Yemen  
Japan  
JP  
JO  
KZ  
KP  
Philippines  
Poland  
Jordan  
Kazakhstan  
North Korea  
Venezuela  
Vietnam  
Portugal  
Puerto Rico  
PT  
PR  
Czech  
Zimbabwe  
Republic  
Denmark  
DK  
SV  
Korea  
KR  
LU  
Slovenia  
SI  
Republic  
Elsalvador  
Luxembourg  
South Africa  
ZA  
Default Setting  
US - for units sold in the United States  
99 (no country set) - for units sold in other countries  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
• If you purchased an AP outside of the United States, the country code must be set before radio  
functions are enabled.  
• The available Country Code settings can be displayed by using the country ? command.  
Example  
Enterprise AP#country tw  
Enterprise AP#  
5.5.2 prompt  
This command customizes the CLI prompt. Use the no form to restore the default  
prompt.  
Syntax  
prompt <string>  
no prompt  
string - Any alphanumeric string to use for the CLI prompt. (Maximum length: 32 characters)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
Enterprise AP  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#prompt RD2  
RD2(config)#  
5.5.3 system name  
This command specifies or modifies the system name for this device. Use the no  
form to restore the default system name.  
Syntax  
system name <name>  
no system name  
name - The name of this host.  
(Maximum length: 32 characters)  
Default Setting  
Enterprise AP  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#system name AP  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.4 username  
This command configures the user name for management access.  
Syntax  
username <name>  
name - The name of the user.  
(Length: 3-16 characters, case sensitive)  
146  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
System Management Commands  
Default Setting  
admin  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#username bob  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.5 password  
After initially logging onto the system, you should set the password. Remember to  
record it in a safe place. Use the no form to reset the default password.  
Syntax  
password <password>  
no password  
password - Password for management access.  
(Length: 3-16 characters, case sensitive)  
Default Setting  
smcadmin  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#password  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.6 ip ssh-server enable  
This command enables the Secure Shell server. Use the no form to disable the  
server.  
Syntax  
ip ssh-server enable  
no ip ssh-server  
Default Setting  
Interface enabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Command Usage  
The AP supports Secure Shell version 2.0 only.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
After boot up, the SSH server needs about two minutes to generate host  
encryption keys. The SSH server is disabled while the keys are being  
generated. The show system command displays the status of the SSH server.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip ssh-server enable  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.5.7 ip ssh-server port  
This command sets the Secure Shell server port. Use the no form to disable the  
server.  
Syntax  
ip ssh-server port <port-number>  
port-number - The UDP port used by the SSH server. (Range: 1-65535)  
Default Setting  
22  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip ssh-server port 1124  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.5.8 ip telnet-server enable  
This command enables the Telnet server. Use the no form to disable the server.  
Syntax  
ip telnet-server enable  
no ip telnet-server  
Default Setting  
Interface enabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip telnet-server enable  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.5.9 ip http port  
This command specifies the TCP port number used by the web browser interface.  
Use the no form to use the default port.  
148  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
System Management Commands  
Syntax  
ip http port <port-number>  
no ip http port  
port-number - The TCP port to be used by the browser interface. (Range: 1024-65535)  
Default Setting  
80  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#ip http port 769  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.5.10 ip http server  
This command allows this device to be monitored or configured from a browser.  
Use the no form to disable this function.  
Syntax  
ip http server  
no ip http server  
Default Setting  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#ip http server  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.5.11 ip http session-timeout  
This command sets the time limit for an idle web interface session.  
Syntax  
ip http session-timeout <time>  
time - Sets the web interface session timeout.  
(Range: 0 - 1800 seconds, 0 means disabled)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
300 seconds  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#ip http session-timeout 0  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.5.12 ip https port  
Use this command to specify the UDP port number used for HTTPS/SSL  
connection to the AP’s Web interface. Use the no form to restore the default port.  
Syntax  
ip https port <port_number>  
no ip https port  
port_number – The UDP port used for HTTPS/SSL.  
(Range: 80, 1024-65535)  
Default Setting  
443  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• You cannot configure the HTTP and HTTPS servers to use the same port.  
• To avoid using common reserved TCP port numbers below 1024, the configurable range is  
restricted to 443 and between 1024 and 65535.  
• If you change the HTTPS port number, clients attempting to connect to the HTTPS server must  
specify the port number in the URL, in this format:  
https://device:port_number  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#ip https port 1234  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.13 ip https server  
Use this command to enable the secure hypertext transfer protocol (HTTPS) over  
the Secure Socket Layer (SSL), providing secure access (i.e., an encrypted  
connection) to the AP’s Web interface. Use the no form to disable this function.  
150  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
System Management Commands  
Syntax  
ip https server  
no ip https server  
Default Setting  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• Both HTTP and HTTPS service can be enabled independently.  
• If you enable HTTPS, you must indicate this in the URL:  
https://device:port_number]  
• When you start HTTPS, the connection is established in this way:  
- The client authenticates the server using the server’s digital certificate.  
- The client and server negotiate a set of security protocols to use for the connection.  
- The client and server generate session keys for encrypting and decrypting data.  
• The client and server establish a secure encrypted connection.  
A padlock icon should appear in the status bar for Internet Explorer 5.x.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#ip https server  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.14 APmgmtIP  
This command specifies the client IP addresses that are allowed management  
access to the AP through various protocols.  
CAUTION  
Secure Web (HTTPS) connections are not affected by the UI Management or IP Management  
settings.  
Syntax  
APmgmtIP <multiple IP_address subnet_mask | single IP_address | any>  
multiple - Adds IP addresses within a specifiable range to the SNMP, web and Telnet groups.  
single - Adds an IP address to the SNMP, web and Telnet groups.  
any - Allows any IP address access through SNMP, web and Telnet groups.  
IP_address - Adds IP addresses to the SNMP, web and Telnet groups.  
subnet_mask - Specifies a range of IP addresses allowed management access.  
Default Setting  
All addresses  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• If anyone tries to access a management interface on the AP from an invalid address, the unit will reject  
the connection, enter an event message in the system log, and send a trap message to the trap  
manager.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
• IP address can be configured for SNMP, web and Telnet access respectively. Each of these groups  
can include up to five different sets of addresses, either individual addresses or address ranges.  
• When entering addresses for the same group (i.e., SNMP, web or Telnet), the AP will not accept  
overlapping address ranges. When entering addresses for different groups, the AP will accept  
overlapping address ranges.  
• You cannot delete an individual address from a specified range. You must delete the entire range, and  
reenter the addresses.  
• You can delete an address range just by specifying the start address, or by specifying both the start  
address and end address.  
Example  
This example restricts management access to the indicated addresses.  
Enterprise AP(config)#apmgmtip multiple 192.168.1.50 255.255.255.0  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.15 APmgmtUI  
This command enables and disables management access to the AP through  
SNMP, Telnet and web interfaces.  
CAUTION  
Secure Web (HTTPS) connections are not affected by the UI Management or IP Management  
settings.  
Syntax  
APmgmtUI <[SNMP | Telnet | Web] enable | disable>  
SNMP - Specifies SNMP management access.  
Telnet - Specifies Telnet management access.  
Web - Specifies web based management access.  
- enable/disable - Enables or disables the selected management access method.  
Default Setting  
All enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
This example restricts management access to the indicated addresses.  
Enterprise AP(config)#apmgmtui SNMP enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.5.16 show apmanagement  
This command shows the AP management configuration, including the IP  
addresses of management stations allowed to access the AP, as well as the  
interface protocols which are open to management access.  
152  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Management Commands  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show apmanagement  
Management AP Information  
=================================  
AP Management IP Mode: Any IP  
Telnet UI: Enable  
WEB UI : Enable  
SNMP UI : Enable  
==================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.5.17 show system  
This command displays basic system configuration settings.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show system  
System Information  
==========================================================  
Serial Number  
System Up time  
System Name  
: A123456789  
: 0 days, 4 hours, 33 minutes, 29 seconds  
: Enterprise wireless gP  
System Location  
System Contact  
:
:
System Country Code : US - UNITED STATES  
MAC Address  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
VLAN State  
: 00-30-F1-F0-9A-9C  
: 192.168.1.1  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 0.0.0.0  
: DISABLED  
Management VLAN ID(AP): 1  
IAPP State  
: ENABLED  
DHCP Client  
HTTP Server  
HTTP Server Port  
HTTPS Server  
HTTPS Server Port  
: ENABLED  
: ENABLED  
: 80  
: ENABLED  
: 443  
Slot Status  
: 802.11g only  
: v2.1.6  
: v4.3.3.8b02  
: ENABLED  
: 22  
: ENABLED  
: DISABLED  
: DISABLED  
: DISABLED  
Boot Rom Version  
Software Version  
SSH Server  
SSH Server Port  
Telnet Server  
WEB Redirect  
DHCP Relay  
Proxy ARP  
==========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.5.18 show version  
This command displays the software version for the system.  
154  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Management Commands  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show version  
Version Information  
=========================================  
Version: v4.3.3.8b02  
Date : Dec 20 2005, 18:38:12  
=========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.5.19 show config  
This command displays detailed configuration information for the system.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show config  
Authentication Information  
===========================================================  
MAC Authentication Server  
: DISABLED  
MAC Auth Session Timeout Value : 0 min  
802.1x supplicant  
: DISABLED  
802.1x supplicant user  
802.1x supplicant password  
Address Filtering  
: EMPTY  
: EMPTY  
: ALLOWED  
System Default : ALLOW addresses not found in filter table.  
Filter Table  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
No Filter Entries.  
Bootfile Information  
===================================  
Bootfile : ec-img.bin  
===================================  
Protocol Filter Information  
===========================================================  
Local Bridge  
AP Management  
:DISABLED  
:ENABLED  
Ethernet Type Filter :DISABLED  
Enabled Protocol Filters  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
No protocol filters are enabled  
===========================================================  
156  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Management Commands  
Hardware Version Information  
===========================================  
Hardware version R01A  
===========================================  
Ethernet Interface Information  
========================================  
IP Address  
: 192.168.0.151  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 192.168.0.1  
: 210.200.211.225  
: 210.200.211.193  
: 100Base-TX Full Duplex  
: Up  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
Primary DNS  
Secondary DNS  
Speed-duplex  
Admin status  
Operational status : Up  
========================================  
Wireless Interface 802.11g Information  
===========================================================  
----------------Identification-----------------------------  
Description  
SSID  
Channel  
Status  
: Enterprise 802.11g Access Point  
: VAP_TEST_11G 0  
: 0 (AUTO)  
: Disable  
----------------802.11 Parameters--------------------------  
Transmit Power  
Data Rate  
: 100% (5 dBm)  
: 54Mbps  
Fragmentation Threshold  
RTS Threshold  
Beacon Interval  
DTIM Interval  
Maximum Association  
Native VLAN ID  
: 2346 bytes  
: 2347 bytes  
: 100 TUs  
: 1 beacon  
: 64 stations  
: 1  
----------------Security-----------------------------------  
Closed System  
: DISABLED  
: WEP  
Multicast cipher  
Unicast cipher  
WPA clients  
WPA Key Mgmt Mode  
WPA PSK Key Type  
Encryption  
: TKIP and AES  
: REQUIRED  
: PRE SHARED KEY  
: ALPHANUMERIC  
: DISABLED  
: 1  
Default Transmit Key  
Static Keys :  
Key 1: EMPTY  
Key Length :  
Key 2: EMPTY  
Key 3: EMPTY  
Key 3: ZERO  
Key 4: EMPTY  
Key 4: ZERO  
Key 1: ZERO  
Key 2: ZERO  
: OPEN  
: Disabled  
Authentication Type  
Rogue AP Detection  
Rogue AP Scan Interval  
Rogue AP Scan Duration  
: 720 minutes  
: 350 milliseconds  
===========================================================  
Console Line Information  
===========================================================  
databits : 8  
parity  
speed  
: none  
: 9600  
stop bits : 1  
===========================================================  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Logging Information  
=====================================================  
Syslog State  
Logging Console State  
Logging Level  
Logging Facility Type  
Servers  
: Disabled  
: Disabled  
: Informational  
: 16  
1: 0.0.0.0  
2: 0.0.0.0  
3: 0.0.0.0  
4: 0.0.0.0  
, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
======================================================  
Radius Server Information  
========================================  
IP  
Port  
Key  
Retransmit  
Timeout  
: 0.0.0.0  
: 1812  
: *****  
: 3  
: 5  
Radius MAC format : no-delimiter  
Radius VLAN format : HEX  
========================================  
Radius Secondary Server Information  
========================================  
IP  
Port  
Key  
Retransmit  
Timeout  
: 0.0.0.0  
: 1812  
: *****  
: 3  
: 5  
Radius MAC format : no-delimiter  
Radius VLAN format : HEX  
========================================  
SNMP Information  
==============================================  
Service State  
Community (ro)  
Community (rw)  
Location  
: Disable  
: ********  
: ********  
:
Contact  
: Contact  
EngineId :80:00:07:e5:80:00:00:29:f6:00:00:00:0c  
EngineBoots:2  
Trap Destinations:  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
158  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Management Commands  
dot11InterfaceGFail Enabled  
dot11InterfaceBFail Enabled  
dot11StationAssociation Enabled dot11StationAuthentication Enabled  
dot11StationReAssociation Enabled  
dot1xAuthFail Enabled  
dot11StationRequestFail Enabled  
dot1xAuthNotInitiated Enabled  
dot1xMacAddrAuthFail Enabled  
iappContextDataSent Enabled  
iappStationRoamedTo Enabled  
localMacAddrAuthSuccess Enabled  
sntpServerFail Enabled  
dot1xAuthSuccess Enabled  
dot1xMacAddrAuthSuccess Enabled  
iappStationRoamedFrom Enabled  
localMacAddrAuthFail Enabled  
pppLogonFail Enabled  
configFileVersionChanged Enabled  
systemDown Enabled  
radiusServerChanged Enabled  
systemUp Enabled  
=============================================  
SNTP Information  
===========================================================  
Service State  
: Disabled  
SNTP (server 1) IP : 137.92.140.80  
SNTP (server 2) IP : 192.43.244.18  
Current Time  
Time Zone  
Daylight Saving  
: 00 : 14, Jan 1st, 1970  
: -5 (BOGOTA, EASTERN, INDIANA)  
: Disabled  
===========================================================  
Station Table Information  
===========================================================  
if-wireless G VAP [0] :  
802.11g Channel : Auto  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
.
.
.
System Information  
==============================================================  
Serial Number  
System Up time  
System Name  
:
: 0 days, 0 hours, 16 minutes, 51 seconds  
: Enterprise wireless gP  
System Location  
System Contact  
:
: Contact  
System Country Code : 99 - NO_COUNTRY_SET  
MAC Address  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
VLAN State  
: 00-12-CF-05-B7-84  
: 192.168.0.151  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 192.168.0.1  
: DISABLED  
Management VLAN ID(AP): 1  
IAPP State  
: ENABLED  
DHCP Client  
HTTP Server  
HTTP Server Port  
HTTPS Server  
HTTPS Server Port  
Slot Status  
: ENABLED  
: ENABLED  
: 80  
: ENABLED  
: 443  
: Dual band(g)  
: v2.1.6  
: v4.3.3.8b02  
Boot Rom Version  
Software Version  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
SSH Server  
: ENABLED  
SSH Server Port  
Telnet Server  
WEB Redirect  
DHCP Relay  
: 22  
: ENABLED  
: DISABLED  
: DISABLED  
==============================================================  
Version Information  
=========================================  
Software Version  
Date  
BootRom Version  
Hardware version  
: v4.3.3.8b02  
: Nov 8 2006, 09:50:03  
: v2.1.6  
: R-00  
=========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.5.20 show hardware  
This command displays the hardware version of the system.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show hardware  
Hardware Version Information  
===========================================  
Hardware version R01  
===========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
160  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Logging Commands  
5.6  
System Logging Commands  
These commands are used to configure system logging on the AP.  
Table 5-7: System Logging Commands  
Command  
logging on  
Function  
Mode  
Page  
Controls logging of error messages  
GC  
GC  
logging host  
Adds a syslog server host IP address that will receive  
logging messages  
logging console  
logging level  
Initiates logging of error messages to the console  
Defines the minimum severity level for event logging  
Sets the facility type for remote logging of syslog messages  
Clears all log entries in AP memory  
GC  
GC  
logging facility-type  
logging clear  
GC  
GC  
show logging  
Displays the state of logging  
Exec  
Exec  
show event-log  
Displays all log entries in AP memory  
5.6.1 logging on  
This command controls logging of error messages; i.e., sending debug or error  
messages to memory. The no form disables the logging process.  
Syntax  
[no] logging on  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The logging process controls error messages saved to memory. You can use the logging level  
command to control the type of error messages that are stored in memory.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging on  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.6.2 logging host  
This command specifies syslog servers host that will receive logging messages.  
Use the no form to remove syslog server host.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Syntax  
logging host <1 | 2 | 3 | 4> <host_name | host_ip_address> [udp_port]  
no logging host <1 | 2 | 3 | 4>  
1 - First syslog server.  
2 - Second syslog server.  
3 - Third syslog server.  
4 - Fourth syslog server.  
host_name - The name of a syslog server. (Range: 1-20 characters)  
host_ip_address - The IP address of a syslog server.  
udp_port - The UDP port used by the syslog server.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging host 1 10.1.0.3  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.6.3 logging console  
This command initiates logging of error messages to the console. Use the no form  
to disable logging to the console.  
Syntax  
logging console  
no logging console  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging console  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.6.4 logging level  
This command sets the minimum severity level for event logging.  
162  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
System Logging Commands  
Syntax  
logging level <Emergency | Alert | Critical | Error | Warning | Notice | Informational | Debug>  
Default Setting  
Informational  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
Messages sent include the selected level down to Emergency level.  
Level Argument  
Description  
Emergency  
Alert  
System unusable  
Immediate action needed  
Critical  
Critical conditions (e.g., memory allocation, or free memory error - resource  
exhausted)  
Error  
Error conditions (e.g., invalid input, default used)  
Warning conditions (e.g., return false, unexpected return)  
Normal but significant condition, such as cold start  
Informational messages only  
Warning  
Notice  
Informational  
Debug  
Debugging messages  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging level alert  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.6.5 logging facility-type  
This command sets the facility type for remote logging of syslog messages.  
Syntax  
logging facility-type <type>  
type - A number that indicates the facility used by the syslog server to dispatch log messages  
to an appropriate service. (Range: 16-23)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
16  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The command specifies the facility type tag sent in syslog messages. (See RFC 3164.) This type  
has no effect on the kind of messages reported by the AP. However, it may be used by the syslog  
server to sort messages or to store messages in the corresponding database.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging facility 19  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.6.6 logging clear  
This command clears all log messages stored in the AP’s memory.  
Syntax  
logging clear  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging clear  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.6.7 show logging  
This command displays the logging configuration.  
164  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
System Logging Commands  
Syntax  
show logging  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show logging  
Logging Information  
============================================  
Syslog State  
Logging Console State  
Logging Level  
Logging Facility Type  
Servers  
: Enabled  
: Enabled  
: Alert  
: 16  
1: 192.168.1.19, UDP Port: 514, State: Enabled  
2: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
3: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
4: 0.0.0.0, UDP Port: 514, State: Disabled  
=============================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.6.8 show event-log  
This command displays log messages stored in the AP’s memory.  
Syntax  
show event-log  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show event-log  
Mar 09 11:57:55 Information: 802.11g:11g Radio Interface Enabled  
Mar 09 11:57:55 Information: 802.11g:Radio channel updated to 8  
Mar 09 11:57:34 Information: 802.11g:11g Radio Interface Enabled  
Mar 09 11:57:18 Information: 802.11g:11g Radio Interface Enabled  
Mar 09 11:55:52 Information: SSH task: Set SSH server port to 22  
Mar 09 11:55:52 Information: SSH task: Enable SSH server.  
Mar 09 11:55:52 Information: Enable Telnet.  
Press <n> next. <p> previous. <a> abort. <y> continue to end :  
Enterprise AP#configure  
Enter configuration commands, one per line. End with CTRL/Z  
Enterprise AP(config)#logging clear  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.7  
System Clock Commands  
These commands are used to configure SNTP and system clock settings on the AP.  
Table 5-8: System Clock Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
sntp-server ip  
Specifies one or more time servers  
Accepts time from the specified time servers  
Manually sets the system date and time  
Sets the start and end dates for daylight savings time  
sntp-server enable  
sntp-server date-time  
GC  
GC  
sntp-server  
GC  
daylight-saving  
sntp-server timezone  
show sntp  
Sets the time zone for the AP’s internal clock  
Shows current SNTP configuration settings  
GC  
Exec  
5.7.1 sntp-server ip  
This command sets the IP address of the servers to which SNTP time requests are  
issued. Use the this command with no arguments to clear all time servers from  
the current list.  
Syntax  
sntp-server ip <1 | 2> <ip>  
1 - First time server.  
2 - Second time server.  
ip - IP address of an time server (NTP or SNTP).  
166  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
System Clock Commands  
Default Setting  
137.92.140.80  
192.43.244.18  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
When SNTP client mode is enabled using the sntp-server enable command, the sntp-server ip  
command specifies the time servers from which the AP polls for time updates. The AP will poll the  
time servers in the order specified until a response is received.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server ip 10.1.0.19  
Enterprise AP#  
Related Commands  
5.7.2 sntp-server enable  
This command enables SNTP client requests for time synchronization with NTP or  
SNTP time servers specified by the sntp-server ip command. Use the no form to  
disable SNTP client requests.  
Syntax  
sntp-server enable  
no sntp-server enable  
Default Setting  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The time acquired from time servers is used to record accurate dates and times for log events.  
Without SNTP, the AP only records the time starting from the factory default set at the last bootup  
(i.e., 00:14:00, January 1, 1970).  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.7.3 sntp-server date-time  
This command sets the system clock.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
00:14:00, January 1, 1970  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
This example sets the system clock to 17:37 June 19, 2003.  
Enterprise AP#sntp-server date-time  
Enter Year<1970-2100>: 2003  
Enter Month<1-12>: 6  
Enter Day<1-31>: 19  
Enter Hour<0-23>: 17  
Enter Min<0-59>: 37  
Enterprise AP#  
Related Commands  
5.7.4 sntp-server daylight-saving  
This command sets the start and end dates for daylight savings time. Use the no  
form to disable daylight savings time.  
Syntax  
sntp-server daylight-saving  
no sntp-server daylight-saving  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The command sets the system clock back one hour during the specified period.  
Example  
This sets daylight savings time to be used from July 1st to September 1st.  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server daylight-saving  
Enter Daylight saving from which month<1-12>: 6  
and which day<1-31>: 1  
Enter Daylight saving end to which month<1-12>: 9  
and which day<1-31>: 1  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.7.5 sntp-server timezone  
This command sets the time zone for the AP’s internal clock.  
168  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
System Clock Commands  
Syntax  
sntp-server timezone <hours>  
hours - Number of hours before/after UTC.  
(Range: -12 to +12 hours)  
Default Setting  
-5 (BOGOTA, EASTERN, INDIANA)  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
This command sets the local time zone relative to the Coordinated Universal Time (UTC, formerly  
Greenwich Mean Time or GMT), based on the earth’s prime meridian, zero degrees longitude. To  
display a time corresponding to your local time, you must indicate the number of hours and  
minutes your time zone is east (before) or west (after) of UTC.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#sntp-server timezone +8  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.7.6 show sntp  
This command displays the current time and configuration settings for the SNTP  
client.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show sntp  
SNTP Information  
=========================================================  
Service State  
: Enabled  
SNTP (server 1) IP : 137.92.140.80  
SNTP (server 2) IP : 192.43.244.18  
Current Time  
Time Zone  
: 08 : 04, Jun 20th, 2003  
: +8 (TAIPEI, BEIJING)  
Daylight Saving  
: Enabled, from Jun, 1st to Sep, 1st  
=========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.8  
DHCP Relay Commands  
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) can dynamically allocate an IP  
address and other configuration information to network clients that broadcast a  
request. To receive the broadcast request, the DHCP server would normally have  
to be on the same subnet as the client. However, when the AP’s DHCP relay agent  
is enabled, received client requests can be forwarded directly by the AP to a known  
DHCP server on another subnet. Responses from the DHCP server are returned to  
the AP, which then broadcasts them back to clients.  
Table 5-9: DHCP Relay Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
dhcp-relay enable  
dhcp-relay  
Enables the DHCP relay agent  
Sets the primary and secondary DHCP server address  
Shows current DHCP relay configuration settings  
GC  
show dhcp-relay  
Exec  
5.8.1 dhcp-relay enable  
This command enables the AP’s DHCP relay agent. Use the no form to disable the  
agent.  
Syntax  
[no] dhcp-relay enable  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• For the DHCP relay agent to function, the primary DHCP server must be configured using the  
dhcp-relay primary command. A secondary DHCP server does not need to be configured, but it is  
recommended.  
• If there is no response from the primary DHCP server, and a secondary server has been configured,  
the agent will then attempt to send DHCP requests to the secondary server.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#dhcp-relay enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.8.2 dhcp-relay  
This command configures the primary and secondary DHCP server addresses.  
170  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DHCP Relay Commands  
Syntax  
dhcp-relay <primary | secondary> <ip_address>  
primary - The primary DHCP server.  
secondary - The secondary DHCP server.  
ip_address - IP address of the server.  
Default Setting  
Primary and secondary: 0.0.0.0  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#dhcp-relay primary 192.168.1.10  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.8.3 show dhcp-relay  
This command displays the current DHCP relay configuration.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show dhcp-relay  
DHCP Relay  
: ENABLED  
Primary DHCP Server : 192.168.1.10  
Secondary DHCP Server : 0.0.0.0  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.9  
SNMP Commands  
Controls access to this AP from management stations using the Simple Network  
Management Protocol (SNMP), as well as the hosts that will receive trap messages.  
Table 5-10: SNMP Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
Page  
snmp-server community  
Sets up the community access string to permit access to  
SNMP commands  
GC  
snmp-server contact  
snmp-server location  
snmp-server enable server  
snmp-server host  
Sets the system contact string  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
GC  
Sets the system location string  
Enables SNMP service and traps  
Specifies the recipient of an SNMP notification operation  
Enables specific SNMP notifications  
Sets the engine ID for SNMP v3  
snmp-server trap  
snmp-server engine id  
snmp-server user  
Sets the name of the SNMP v3 user  
Configures SNMP v3 notification targets  
Configures SNMP v3 notification filters  
Assigns SNMP v3 notification filters to targets  
snmp-server targets  
snmp-server filter  
snmp-server  
filter-assignments  
show snmp groups  
show snmp users  
Displays the pre-defined SNMP v3 groups  
Displays SNMP v3 user settings  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
show snmp  
Displays the assignment of users to SNMP v3 groups  
group-assignments  
show snmp target  
show snmp filter  
Displays the SNMP v3 notification targets  
Displays the SNMP v3 notification filters  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
show snmp filter-assignments  
show snmp  
Displays the SNMP v3 notification filter assignments  
Displays the status of SNMP communications  
5.9.1 snmp-server community  
This command defines the community access string for the Simple Network  
Management Protocol. Use the no form to remove the specified community string.  
Syntax  
snmp-server community string [ro | rw]  
no snmp-server community string  
string - Community string that acts like a password and permits access to the SNMP protocol.  
172  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
SNMP Commands  
(Maximum length: 23 characters, case sensitive)  
ro - Specifies read-only access. Authorized management stations are only able to retrieve MIB  
objects.  
rw - Specifies read/write access. Authorized management stations are able to both retrieve and  
modify MIB objects.  
Default Setting  
• public - Read-only access. Authorized management stations are only able to retrieve MIB objects.  
• private - Read/write access. Authorized management stations are able to both retrieve and  
modify MIB objects.  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
If you enter a community string without the ro or rw option, the default is read only.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server community alpha rw  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.9.2 snmp-server contact  
This command sets the system contact string. Use the no form to remove the  
system contact information.  
Syntax  
snmp-server contact string  
no snmp-server contact  
string - String that describes the system contact. (Maximum length: 255 characters)  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server contact Paul  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.9.3 snmp-server location  
This command sets the system location string. Use the no form to remove the  
location string.  
Syntax  
snmp-server location <text>  
no snmp-server location  
text - String that describes the system location. (Maximum length: 255 characters)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server location WC-19  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.9.4 snmp-server enable server  
This command enables SNMP management access and also enables this device to  
send SNMP traps (i.e., notifications). Use the no form to disable SNMP service and  
trap messages.  
Syntax  
snmp-server enable server  
no snmp-server enable server  
Default Setting  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• This command enables both authentication failure notifications and link-up-down notifications.  
• The snmp-server host command specifies the host device that will receive SNMP notifications.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server enable server  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.9.5 snmp-server host  
This command specifies the recipient of an SNMP notification. Use the no form to  
remove the specified host.  
Syntax  
snmp-server host <1 | 2 | 3 | 4> <host_ip_address | host_name> <community-string>  
no snmp-server host  
1 - First SNMP host.  
2 - Second SNMP host.  
3 - Third SNMP host.  
4 - Fourth SNMP host.  
174  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
SNMP Commands  
host_ip_address - IP of the host (the targeted recipient).  
host_name - Name of the host. (Range: 1-63 characters)  
community-string - Password-like community string sent with the notification operation. Although  
you can set this string using the snmp-server host command by itself, we recommend that you  
define this string using the snmp-server community command prior to using the snmp-server  
host command. (Maximum length: 23 characters)  
Default Setting  
Host Address: None  
Community String: public  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The snmp-server host command is used in conjunction with the snmp-server enable server  
command to enable SNMP notifications.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server host 1 10.1.19.23 batman  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.9.6 snmp-server trap  
This command enables the AP to send specific SNMP traps (i.e., notifications). Use  
the no form to disable specific trap messages.  
Syntax  
snmp-server trap <trap>  
no snmp-server trap <trap>  
trap - One of the following SNMP trap messages:  
- dot11InterfaceGFail - The 802.11g interface has failed.  
- dot11InterfaceBFail - The 802.11b interface has failed.  
- dot11StationAssociation - A client station has successfully associated with the AP.  
- dot11StationAuthentication - A client station has been successfully authenticated.  
- dot11StationReAssociation - A client station has successfully re-associated with the AP.  
- dot11StationRequestFail - A client station has failed association, re-association, or  
authentication.  
- dot1xAuthFail - A 802.1X client station has failed RADIUS authentication.  
- dot1xAuthNotInitiated - A client station did not initiate 802.1X authentication.  
- dot1xAuthSuccess - A 802.1X client station has been successfully authenticated by the  
RADIUS server.  
- dot1xMacAddrAuthFail - A client station has failed MAC address authentication with the  
RADIUS server.  
- dot1xMacAddrAuthSuccess - A client station has successfully authenticated its MAC  
address with the RADIUS server.  
- iappContextDataSent - A client station’s Context Data has been sent to another AP with  
which the station has associated.  
- iappStationRoamedFrom - A client station has roamed from another AP (identified by its IP  
address).  
- iappStationRoamedTo - A client station has roamed to another AP (identified by its IP  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
address).  
- localMacAddrAuthFail - A client station has failed authentication with the local MAC address  
database on the AP.  
- localMacAddrAuthSuccess - A client station has successfully authenticated its MAC address  
with the local database on the AP.  
- pppLogonFail - The AP has failed to log onto the PPPoE server using the configured user  
name and password.  
- sntpServerFail - The AP has failed to set the time from the configured SNTP server.  
- sysConfigFileVersionChanged - The AP’s configuration file has been changed.  
- sysRadiusServerChanged - The AP has changed from the primary RADIUS server to the  
secondary, or from the secondary to the primary.  
- sysSystemDown - The AP is about to shutdown and reboot.  
- sysSystemUp - The AP is up and running.  
Default Setting  
All traps enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
This command is used in conjunction with the snmp-server host and snmp-server enable  
server commands to enable SNMP notifications.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#no snmp-server trap dot11StationAssociation  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.9.7 snmp-server engine-id  
This command is used for SNMP v3. It is used to uniquely identify the AP among  
all APs in the network. Use the no form to delete the engine ID.  
Syntax  
snmp-server engine-id <engine-id>  
no snmp-server engine-id  
engine-id - Enter engine-id in hexadecimal (5-32 characters).  
Default Setting  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• This command is used in conjunction with the snmp-server user command.  
• Entering this command invalidates all engine IDs that have been previously configured.  
• If the engine ID is deleted or changed, all SNMP users will be cleared. You will need to  
reconfigure all existing users  
176  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server engine-id 1a:2b:3c:4d:00:ff  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.9.8 snmp-server user  
This command configures the SNMP v3 users that are allowed to manage the AP.  
Use the no form to delete an SNMP v3 user.  
Syntax  
snmp-server user <user-name>  
user-name - A user-defined string for the SNMP user. (32 characters maximum)  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• Up to 10 SNMPv3 users can be configured on the AP.  
• The SNMP engine ID is used to compute the authentication/privacy digests from the pass phrase.  
You should therefore configure the engine ID with the snmp-server engine-id command before  
using this configuration command.  
• The AP enables SNMP v3 users to be assigned to three pre-defined groups. Other groups cannot  
be defined. The available groups are:  
- RO - A read-only group using no authentication and no data encryption. Users in this group  
use no security, either authentication or encryption, in SNMP messages they send to the agent.  
This is the same as SNMP v1 or SNMP v2c.  
- RWAuth - A read/write group using authentication, but no data encryption. Users in this group  
send SNMP messages that use an MD5 key/password for authentication, but not a DES  
key/password for encryption.  
- RWPriv - A read/write group using authentication and data encryption. Users in this group send  
SNMP messages that use an MD5 key/password for authentication and a DES key/password  
for encryption. Both the MD5 and DES key/passwords must be defined.  
• The command prompts for the following information to configure an SNMP v3 user:  
- user-name - A user-defined string for the SNMP user. (32 characters maximum)  
- group-name - The name of the SNMP group to which the user is assigned (32 characters  
maximum). There are three pre-defined groups: RO, RWAuth, or RWPriv.  
- auth-proto - The authentication type used for user authentication: md5 or none.  
- auth-passphrase - The user password required when authentication is used  
(8 – 32 characters).  
- priv-proto - The encryption type used for SNMP data encryption: des or none.  
- priv-passphrase - The user password required when data encryption is used  
(8 – 32 characters).  
• Users must be assigned to groups that have the same security levels. If a user who has “AuthPriv”  
security (uses authentication and encryption) is assigned to a read-only (RO) group, the user will  
not be able to access the database. An AuthPriv user must be assigned to the RWPriv group with  
the AuthPriv security level.  
• To configure a user for the RWAuth group, you must include the auth-proto and auth-passphrase  
keywords.  
• To configure a user for the RWPriv group, you must include the auth-proto, auth-passphrase,  
priv-proto, and priv-passphrase keywords.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server user  
User Name<1-32> :chris  
Group Name<1-32> :RWPriv  
Authtype(md5,<cr>none):md5  
Passphrase<8-32>:a good secret  
Privacy(des,<cr>none) :des  
Passphrase<8-32>:a very good secret  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.9.9 snmp-server targets  
This command configures SNMP v3 notification targets. Use the no form to delete  
an SNMP v3 target.  
Syntax  
snmp-server targets <target-id> <ip-addr> <sec-name>  
[version {3}] [udp-port {port-number}] [notification-type  
{TRAP}]  
no snmp-server targets <target-id>  
target-id - A user-defined name that identifies a receiver of SNMP notifications. (Maximum length:  
32 characters)  
ip-addr - Specifies the IP address of the management station to receive notifications.  
sec-name - The defined SNMP v3 user name that is to receive notifications.  
version - The SNMP version of notifications. Currently only version 3 is supported in this  
command.  
udp-port - The UDP port that is used on the receiving management station for notifications.  
notification-type - The type of notification that is sent. Currently only TRAP is supported.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• The AP supports up to 10 SNMP v3 target IDs.  
• The SNMP v3 user name that is specified in the target must first be configured using the  
snmp-server user command.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server targets mytraps 192.168.1.33 chris  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.9.10 snmp-server filter  
This command configures SNMP v3 notification filters. Use the no form to delete  
an SNMP v3 filter or remove a subtree from a filter.  
178  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SNMP Commands  
Syntax  
snmp-server filter <filter-id> <include | exclude> <subtree>  
[mask {mask}]  
no snmp-server filter <filter-id> [subtree]  
filter-id - A user-defined name that identifies an SNMP v3 notification filter. (Maximum length: 32  
characters)  
include - Defines a filter type that includes objects in the MIB subtree.  
exclude - Defines a filter type that excludes objects in the MIB subtree.  
subtree - The part of the MIB subtree that is to be filtered.  
mask - An optional hexadecimal value bit mask to define objects in the MIB subtree.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• The AP allows up to 10 notification filters to be created. Each filter can be defined by up to 20 MIB  
subtree ID entries.  
• Use the command more than once with the same filter ID to build a filter that includes or excludes  
multiple MIB objects. Note that the filter entries are applied in the sequence that they are defined.  
• The MIB subtree must be defined in the form “.1.3.6.1” and always start with a “.”.  
• The mask is a hexadecimal value with each bit masking the corresponding ID in the MIB subtree.  
A “1” in the mask indicates an exact match and a “0” indicates a “wild card.” For example, a mask  
value of 0xFFBF provides a bit mask “1111 1111 1011 1111.” If applied to the subtree  
1.3.6.1.2.1.2.2.1.1.23, the zero corresponds to the 10th subtree ID. When there are more subtree  
IDs than bits in the mask, the mask is padded with ones.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server filter trapfilter include .1  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server filter trapfilter exclude .1.3.6.1.2.1.2.2.1.1.23  
5.9.11 snmp-server filter-assignments  
This command assigns SNMP v3 notification filters to targets. Use the no form to  
remove an SNMP v3 filter assignment.  
Syntax  
snmp-server filter-assignments <target-id> <filter-id>  
no snmp-server filter-assignments <target-id>  
target-id - A user-defined name that identifies a receiver of SNMP notifications. (Maximum length:  
32 characters)  
filter-id - A user-defined name that identifies an SNMP v3 notification filter. (Maximum length: 32  
characters)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#snmp-server filter-assignments mytraps trapfilter  
Enterprise AP(config)#exit  
Enterprise AP#show snmp target  
Host ID  
User  
: mytraps  
: chris  
IP Address : 192.168.1.33  
UDP Port : 162  
=============================  
Enterprise AP#show snmp filter-assignments  
HostID FilterID  
mytraps trapfilter  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.9.12 show snmp groups  
This command displays the SNMP v3 pre-defined groups.  
Syntax  
show snmp groups  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp groups  
GroupName  
:RO  
SecurityModel :USM  
SecurityLevel :NoAuthNoPriv  
GroupName  
:RWAuth  
SecurityModel :USM  
SecurityLevel :AuthNoPriv  
GroupName  
:RWPriv  
SecurityModel :USM  
SecurityLevel :AuthPriv  
Enterprise AP#  
5.9.13 show snmp users  
This command displays the SNMP v3 users and settings.  
180  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SNMP Commands  
Syntax  
show snmp users  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp users  
=============================================  
UserName  
GroupName  
AuthType  
:chris  
:RWPriv  
:MD5  
Passphrase:****************  
PrivType  
:DES  
Passphrase:****************  
=============================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.9.14 show snmp group-assignments  
This command displays the SNMP v3 user group assignments.  
Syntax  
show snmp group-assignments  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp group-assignments  
GroupName  
UserName  
:RWPriv  
:chris  
Enterprise AP#  
Enterprise AP#  
5.9.15 show snmp target  
This command displays the SNMP v3 notification target settings.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Syntax  
show snmp target  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp target  
Host ID  
User  
: mytraps  
: chris  
IP Address : 192.168.1.33  
UDP Port : 162  
=============================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.9.16 show snmp filter  
This command displays the SNMP v3 notification filter settings.  
Syntax  
show snmp filter [filter-id]  
filter-id - A user-defined name that identifies an SNMP v3 notification filter. (Maximum length: 32  
characters)  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp filter  
Filter: trapfilter  
Type: include  
Subtree: iso.3.6.1.2.1.2.2.1  
Type: exclude  
Subtree: iso.3.6.1.2.1.2.2.1.1.23  
=============================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.9.17 show snmp filter-assignments  
This command displays the SNMP v3 notification filter assignments.  
182  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SNMP Commands  
Syntax  
show snmp filter-assignments  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp filter-assignments  
HostID FilterID  
mytraps trapfilter  
Enterprise AP#  
5.9.18 show snmp  
This command displays the SNMP configuration settings.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show snmp  
SNMP Information  
==============================================  
Service State  
Community (ro)  
Community (rw)  
Location  
: Enable  
: *****  
: *****  
: WC-19  
: Paul  
Contact  
EngineId :80:00:07:e5:80:00:00:2e:62:00:00:00:18  
EngineBoots:1  
Trap Destinations:  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
192.168.1.9, Community: *****, State: Enabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
0.0.0.0, Community: *****, State: Disabled  
dot11InterfaceGFail Enabled  
dot11InterfaceBFail Enabled  
dot11StationAssociation Enabled dot11StationAuthentication  
Enabled  
dot11StationReAssociation Enabled  
Enabled  
dot11StationRequestFail  
dot1xAuthFail Enabled  
dot1xAuthSuccess Enabled  
dot1xAuthNotInitiated Enabled  
dot1xMacAddrAuthFail Enabled  
dot1xMacAddrAuthSuccess Enabled  
Enabled  
iappContextDataSent  
iappStationRoamedFrom Enabled  
Enabled  
iappStationRoamedTo  
localMacAddrAuthFail Enabled  
pppLogonFail Enabled  
configFileVersionChanged Enabled  
Enabled  
localMacAddrAuthSuccess Enabled  
sntpServerFail Enabled  
radiusServerChanged  
systemDown Enabled  
systemUp Enabled  
=============================================  
Enterprise AP#  
184  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Flash/File Commands  
5.10 Flash/File Commands  
These commands are used to manage the system code or configuration files.  
Table 5-11: Flash/File Commands  
Command  
bootfile  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
Specifies the file or image used to start up the system  
copy  
Copies a code image or configuration between flash  
memory and a FTP/TFTP server  
Exec  
delete  
Deletes a file or code image  
Exec  
Exec  
Exec  
dir  
Displays a list of files in flash memory  
Displays the name of the current operation code file that  
booted the system  
show bootfile  
5.10.1 bootfile  
This command specifies the image used to start up the system.  
Syntax  
bootfile <filename>  
filename - Name of the image file.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
• The file name should not contain slashes (\ or /), the leading letter of the file name should not be  
a period (.), and the maximum length for file names is 32 characters. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z,  
0-9, “.”, “-”, “_”)  
• If the file contains an error, it cannot be set as the default file.  
Example  
Enterprise AP#bootfile -img.bin  
Enterprise AP#  
5.10.2 copy  
This command copies a boot file, code image, or configuration file between the  
AP’s flash memory and a FTP/TFTP server. When you save the configuration  
settings to a file on a FTP/TFTP server, that file can later be downloaded to the AP  
to restore system operation. The success of the file transfer depends on the  
accessibility of the FTP/TFTP server and the quality of the network connection.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Syntax  
copy <ftp | tftp> file  
copy config <ftp | tftp>  
ftp - Keyword that allows you to copy to/from an FTP server.  
tftp - Keyword that allows you to copy to/from a TFTP server.  
file - Keyword that allows you to copy to/from a flash memory file.  
config - Keyword that allows you to upload the configuration file from flash memory.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
• The system prompts for data required to complete the copy command.  
• Only a configuration file can be uploaded to an FTP/TFTP server, but every type of file can be  
downloaded to the AP.  
The destination file name should not contain slashes (\ or /), the leading letter of the file name  
should not be a period (.), and the maximum length for file names on the FTP/TFTP server is 255  
characters or 32 characters for files on the AP. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z, 0-9, “.”, “-”, “_”)  
• Due to the size limit of the flash memory, the AP supports only two operation code files.  
• The system configuration file must be named “syscfg” in all copy commands.  
Example  
The following example shows how to upload the configuration settings to a file on  
the TFTP server:  
Enterprise AP#copy config tftp  
TFTP Source file name:syscfg  
TFTP Server IP:192.168.1.19  
Enterprise AP#  
The following example shows how to download a configuration file:  
Enterprise AP#copy tftp file  
1. Application image  
2. Config file  
3. Boot block image  
Select the type of download<1,2,3>: [1]:2  
TFTP Source file name:syscfg  
TFTP Server IP:192.168.1.19  
Enterprise AP#  
5.10.3 delete  
This command deletes a file or image.  
Syntax  
delete <filename>  
filename - Name of the configuration file or image name.  
186  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Flash/File Commands  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
CAUTION  
Beware of deleting application images from flash memory. At least one application image is  
required in order to boot the AP. If there are multiple image files in flash memory, and the one used  
to boot the AP is deleted, be sure you first use the bootfile command to update the application  
image file booted at startup before you reboot the AP.  
Example  
This example shows how to delete the test.cfg configuration file from flash  
memory.  
Enterprise AP#delete test.cfg  
Are you sure you wish to delete this file? <y/n>:  
Enterprise AP#  
Related Commands  
5.10.4 dir  
This command displays a list of files in flash memory.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Command Usage  
File information is shown below:  
Column Heading  
File Name  
Type  
Description  
The name of the file.  
(2) Operation Code and (5) Configuration file  
The length of the file in bytes.  
File Size  
Example  
The following example shows how to display all file information:  
Enterprise AP#dir  
File Name  
Type File Size  
---- -----------  
--------------------------  
dflt-img.bin  
syscfg  
syscfg_bak  
zz-img.bin  
2
5
5
2
1044140  
16860  
16860  
1044140  
1048576 byte(s) available  
Enterprise AP#  
5.10.5 show bootfile  
This command displays the name of the current operation code file that booted  
the system.  
Syntax  
show snmp filter-assignments  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show bootfile  
Bootfile Information  
===================================  
Bootfile : ec-img.bin  
===================================  
Enterprise AP#  
188  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RADIUS Client  
5.11 RADIUS Client  
Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) is a logon authentication  
protocol that uses software running on a central server to control access for  
RADIUS-aware devices to the network. An authentication server contains a  
database of credentials, such as users names and passwords, for each wireless  
client that requires access to the AP.  
Table 5-12: RADIUS Client  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
radius-server address  
radius-server port  
radius-server key  
radius-server retransmit  
radius-server timeout  
Specifies the RADIUS server  
Sets the RADIUS server network port  
Sets the RADIUS encryption key  
Sets the number of retries  
GC  
GC  
GC  
Sets the interval between sending authentication  
requests  
GC  
radius-server port-accounting  
radius-server timeout-interim  
Sets the RADIUS Accounting server network port  
GC  
GC  
Sets the interval between transmitting accounting  
updates to the RADIUS server  
radius-server  
Sets the format for specifying MAC addresses on the  
RADIUS server  
GC  
radius-mac-format  
radius-server vlan-format  
show radius  
Sets the format for specifying VLAN IDs on the RADIUS  
server  
GC  
Shows the current RADIUS settings  
Exec  
5.11.1 radius-server address  
This command specifies the primary and secondary RADIUS servers.  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] address <host_ip_address | host_name>  
secondary - Secondary server.  
host_ip_address - IP address of server.  
host_name - Host name of server. (Range: 1-20 characters)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server address 192.168.1.25  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.2 radius-server port  
This command sets the RADIUS server network port.  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] port <port_number>  
secondary - Secondary server.  
port_number - RADIUS server UDP port used for authentication messages.  
(Range: 1024-65535)  
Default Setting  
1812  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server port 181  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.3 radius-server key  
This command sets the RADIUS encryption key.  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] key <key_string>  
secondary - Secondary server.  
key_string - Encryption key used to authenticate logon access for client. Do not use blank spaces  
in the string. (Maximum length: 20 characters)  
Default Setting  
DEFAULT  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server key green  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.4 radius-server retransmit  
This command sets the number of retries.  
190  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
RADIUS Client  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] retransmit number_of_retries  
secondary - Secondary server.  
number_of_retries - Number of times the AP will try to authenticate logon access via the RADIUS  
server. (Range: 1 - 30)  
Default Setting  
3
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server retransmit 5  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.5 radius-server timeout  
This command sets the interval between transmitting authentication requests to  
the RADIUS server.  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] timeout number_of_seconds  
secondary - Secondary server.  
number_of_seconds - Number of seconds the AP waits for a reply before resending a request.  
(Range: 1-60)  
Default Setting  
5
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server timeout 10  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.6 radius-server port-accounting  
This command sets the RADIUS Accounting server network port.  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] port-accounting <port_number>  
secondary - Secondary server. If secondary is not specified, then the AP assumes you are  
configuring the primary RADIUS server.  
port_number - RADIUS Accounting server UDP port used for accounting messages.  
(Range: 0 or 1024-65535)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
0 (disabled)  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• When the RADIUS Accounting server UDP port is specified, a RADIUS accounting session is  
automatically started for each user that is successfully authenticated to the AP.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server port-accounting 1813  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.7 radius-server timeout-interim  
This command sets the interval between transmitting accounting updates to the  
RADIUS server.  
Syntax  
radius-server [secondary] timeout-interim <number_of_seconds>  
secondary - Secondary server.  
number_of_seconds - Number of seconds the waits between transmitting accounting updates.  
(Range: 60-86400)  
Default Setting  
3600  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• The  
sends periodic accounting updates after every interim period until the user logs off and a “stop”  
message is sent.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server timeout-interim 500  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.8 radius-server radius-mac-format  
This command sets the format for specifying MAC addresses on the RADIUS  
server.  
Syntax  
radius-server radius-mac-format <multi-colon | multi-dash | no-delimiter | single-dash>  
multi-colon - Enter MAC addresses in the form xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.  
multi-dash - Enter MAC addresses in the form xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx.  
no-delimiter - Enter MAC addresses in the form xxxxxxxxxxxx.  
single-dash - Enter MAC addresses in the form xxxxxx-xxxxxx.  
192  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
RADIUS Client  
Default Setting  
No delimiter  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server radius-mac-format multi-dash  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.9 radius-server vlan-format  
This command sets the format for specifying VLAN IDs on the RADIUS server.  
Syntax  
radius-server vlan-format <hex | ascii>  
hex - Enter VLAN IDs as a hexadecimal number.  
ascii - Enter VLAN IDs as an ASCII string.  
Default Setting  
Hex  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#radius-server vlan-format ascii  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.11.10 show radius  
This command displays the current settings for the RADIUS server.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show radius  
Radius Server Information  
========================================  
IP  
Port  
Key  
Retransmit  
Timeout  
: 0.0.0.0  
: 1812  
: *****  
: 3  
: 5  
Radius MAC format : no-delimiter  
Radius VLAN format : HEX  
========================================  
Radius Secondary Server Information  
========================================  
IP  
Port  
Key  
Retransmit  
Timeout  
: 0.0.0.0  
: 1812  
: *****  
: 3  
: 5  
Radius MAC format : no-delimiter  
Radius VLAN format : HEX  
========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
194  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
802.1X Authentication  
5.12 802.1X Authentication  
The AP supports IEEE 802.1X access control for wireless clients. This control  
feature prevents unauthorized access to the network by requiring an 802.1X  
client application to submit user credentials for authentication. Client  
authentication is then verified by a RADIUS server using EAP (Extensible  
Authentication Protocol) before the AP grants client access to the network. The  
802.1X EAP packets are also used to pass dynamic unicast session keys and  
static broadcast keys to wireless clients.  
Table 5-13: 802.1X Authentication  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
Page  
802.1x  
Configures 802.1X as disabled, supported, or required  
IC-W-VAP 195  
802.1x broadcast-key-  
refresh-rate  
Sets the interval at which the primary broadcast keys are  
refreshed for stations using 802.1X dynamic keying  
IC-W-VAP  
802.1x session-key-  
refresh-rate  
Sets the interval at which unicast session keys are  
refreshed for associated stations using dynamic keying  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W-VAP  
802.1x session-timeout  
Sets the timeout after which a connected client must be  
re-authenticated  
802.1x-supplicant enable  
802.1x-supplicant user  
show authentication  
Enables the AP to operate as a 802.1X supplicant  
GC  
Sets the supplicant user name and password for the AP  
GC  
Shows all 802.1X authentication settings, as well as the  
address filter table  
Exec  
5.12.1 802.1x  
This command configures 802.1X as optionally supported or as required for  
wireless clients. Use the no form to disable 802.1X support.  
Syntax  
802.1x <supported | required>  
no 802.1x  
supported - Authenticates clients that initiate the 802.1X authentication process. Uses standard  
802.11 authentication for all others.  
required - Requires 802.1X authentication for all clients.  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• When 802.1X is disabled, the AP does not support 802.1X authentication for any station. After  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
successful 802.11 association, each client is allowed to access the network.  
• When 802.1X is supported, the AP supports 802.1X authentication only for clients initiating the  
802.1X authentication process (i.e., the AP does NOT initiate 802.1X authentication). For stations  
initiating 802.1X, only those stations successfully authenticated are allowed to access the  
network. For those stations not initiating 802.1X, access to the network is allowed after successful  
802.11 association.  
• When 802.1X is required, the AP enforces 802.1X authentication for all 802.11 associated  
stations. If 802.1X authentication is not initiated by the station, the AP will initiate authentication.  
Only those stations successfully authenticated with 802.1X are allowed to access the network.  
• 802.1X does not apply to the 10/100Base-TX port.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#802.1x supported  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.12.2 802.1x-supplicant enable  
This command enables the AP to operate as an 802.1X supplicant for  
authentication. Use the no form to disable 802.1X authentication of the AP.  
Syntax  
802.1x-supplicant enable  
no 802.1x-supplicant  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
A user name and password must be configured first before the 802.1X supplicant feature can be  
enabled.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#802.1x-supplicant enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.12.3 802.1x-supplicant user  
This command sets the user name and password used for authentication of the  
AP when operating as a 802.1X supplicant. Use the no form to clear the  
supplicant user name and password.  
Syntax  
802.1x-supplicant user <username> <password>  
no 802.1x-supplicant user  
username - The AP name used for authentication to the network. (Range: 1-32 alphanumeric  
characters)  
password - The MD5 password used for AP authentication. (Range: 1-32 alphanumeric  
characters)  
196  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
802.1X Authentication  
Default  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The AP currently only supports EAP-MD5 CHAP for 802.1X supplicant authentication.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#802.1x-supplicant user WA6102 dot1xpass  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.12.4 show authentication  
This command shows all 802.1X authentication settings, as well as the address  
filter table.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show authentication  
Authentication Information  
===========================================================  
MAC Authentication Server  
: DISABLED  
MAC Auth Session Timeout Value : 0 min  
802.1x supplicant  
: DISABLED  
802.1x supplicant user  
802.1x supplicant password  
Address Filtering  
: EMPTY  
: EMPTY  
: ALLOWED  
System Default : ALLOW addresses not found in filter table.  
Filter Table  
MAC Address  
Status  
-----------------  
00-70-50-cc-99-1a  
00-70-50-cc-99-1b  
----------  
DENIED  
ALLOWED  
=========================================================  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.13 MAC Address Authentication  
Use these commands to define MAC authentication on the AP. For local MAC  
authentication, first define the default filtering policy using the address filter  
default command. Then enter the MAC addresses to be filtered, indicating if they  
are allowed or denied. For RADIUS MAC authentication, the MAC addresses and  
filtering policy must be configured on the RADIUS server.  
Table 5-14: MAC Address Authentication  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
address filter default  
address filter entry  
address filter delete  
mac- authentication server  
Sets filtering to allow or deny listed addresses  
Enters a MAC address in the filter table  
Removes a MAC address from the filter table  
GC  
GC  
Sets address filtering to be performed with local or remote  
options  
GC  
mac- authentication  
session-timeout  
Sets the interval at which associated clients will be  
re-authenticated with the RADIUS server authentication  
database  
GC  
show authentication  
Shows all 802.1X authentication settings, as well as the  
address filter table  
Exec  
5.13.1 address filter default  
This command sets filtering to allow or deny listed MAC addresses.  
Syntax  
address filter default <allowed | denied>  
allowed - Only MAC addresses entered as “denied” in the address filtering table are denied.  
denied - Only MAC addresses entered as “allowed” in the address filtering table are allowed.  
198  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
MAC Address Authentication  
Default  
allowed  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter default denied  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.13.2 address filter entry  
This command enters a MAC address in the filter table.  
Syntax  
address filter entry <mac-address> <allowed | denied>  
mac-address - Physical address of client. (Enter six pairs of hexadecimal digits separated by  
hyphens; e.g., 00-90-D1-12-AB-89.)  
allowed - Entry is allowed access.  
denied - Entry is denied access.  
Default  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Mode  
• The AP supports up to 1024 MAC addresses.  
• An entry in the address table may be allowed or denied access depending on the global setting  
configured for the address entry default command.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter entry 00-70-50-cc-99-1a allowed  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.13.3 address filter delete  
This command deletes a MAC address from the filter table.  
Syntax  
address filter delete <mac-address>  
mac-address - Physical address of client. (Enter six pairs of hexadecimal digits separated by  
hyphens.)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#address filter delete 00-70-50-cc-99-1b  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.13.4 mac-authentication server  
This command sets address filtering to be performed with local or remote options.  
Use the no form to disable MAC address authentication.  
Syntax  
mac-authentication server [local | remote]  
local - Authenticate the MAC address of wireless clients with the local authentication database  
during 802.11 association.  
remote - Authenticate the MAC address of wireless clients with the RADIUS server during 802.1X  
authentication.  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#mac-authentication server remote  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.13.5 mac-authentication session-timeout  
This command sets the interval at which associated clients will be  
re-authenticated with the RADIUS server authentication database. Use the no  
form to disable reauthentication.  
Syntax  
mac-authentication session-timeout <minutes>  
minutes - Re-authentication interval. (Range: 0-1440)  
200  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MAC Address Authentication  
Default  
0 (disabled)  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#mac-authentication session-timeout 1  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.14 Filtering Commands  
The commands described in this section are used to filter communications  
between wireless clients, control access to the management interface from  
wireless clients, and filter traffic using specific Ethernet protocol types.  
Table 5-15: Filtering Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
filter local-bridge  
filter ap-manage  
Disables communication between wireless clients  
Prevents wireless clients from accessing the management  
interface  
GC  
filter uplink enable  
filter uplink  
Ethernet port MAC address filtering  
GC  
GC  
GC  
Adds or deletes a MAC address from the filtering table  
filter ethernet-type enable  
Checks the Ethernet type for all incoming and outgoing  
Ethernet packets against the protocol filtering table  
filter ethernet-type protocol  
show filters  
Sets a filter for a specific Ethernet type  
Shows the filter configuration  
GC  
Exec  
202  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Filtering Commands  
5.14.1 filter local-bridge  
This command disables communication between wireless clients. Use the no form  
to disable this filtering.  
Syntax  
filter local-bridge <all-VAP | intra-VAP>  
no filter local-bridge  
all-VAP - When enabled, clients cannot establish wireless communications with any other client,  
either those associated to the same VAP interface or any other VAP interface.  
intra-VAP - When enabled, clients associated with a specific VAP interface cannot establish  
wireless communications with each other. Clients can communicate with clients associated to  
other VAP interfaces.  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
This command can disable wireless-to-wireless communications between clients via the AP.  
However, it does not affect communications between wireless clients and the wired network.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter local-bridge  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.14.2 filter ap-manage  
This command prevents wireless clients from accessing the management interface  
on the AP. Use the no form to disable this filtering.  
Syntax  
filter ap-manage  
no filter ap-manage  
Default  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter AP-manage  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.14.3 filter uplink enable  
This command enables filtering of MAC addresses from the Ethernet port.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Syntax  
[no] filter uplink enable  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter uplink enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.14.4 filter uplink  
This command adds or deletes MAC addresses from the uplink filtering table.  
Syntax  
filter uplink <add | delete> MAC address  
MAC address - Specifies a MAC address in the form xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx.  
A maximum of four addresses can be added to the filtering table.  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter uplink add 00-12-34-56-78-9a  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.14.5 filter ethernet-type enable  
This command checks the Ethernet type on all incoming and outgoing Ethernet  
packets against the protocol filtering table. Use the no form to disable this feature.  
204  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Filtering Commands  
Syntax  
filter ethernet-type enable  
no filter ethernet-type enable  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
This command is used in conjunction with the filter ethernet-type protocol command to  
determine which Ethernet protocol types are to be filtered.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter ethernet-type enable  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.14.6 filter ethernet-type protocol  
This command sets a filter for a specific Ethernet type. Use the no form to disable  
filtering for a specific Ethernet type.  
Syntax  
filter ethernet-type protocol <protocol>  
no filter ethernet-type protocol <protocol>  
protocol - An Ethernet protocol type. (Options: ARP, RARP, Berkeley-Trailer-Negotiation,  
LAN-Test, X25-Level-3, Banyan, CDP, DEC XNS, DEC-MOP-Dump-Load, DEC-MOP,  
DEC-LAT, Ethertalk, Appletalk-ARP, Novell-IPX(old), Novell-IPX(new), EAPOL, Telxon-TXP,  
Aironet-DDP, Enet-Config-Test, IP, IPv6, NetBEUI, PPPoE_Discovery, PPPoE_PPP_Session)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
Use the filter ethernet-type enable command to enable filtering for Ethernet types specified in the  
filtering table, or the no filter ethernet-type enable command to disable all filtering based on the  
filtering table.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#filter ethernet-type protocol ARP  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.14.7 show filters  
This command shows the filter options and protocol entries in the filter table.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show filters  
Protocol Filter Information  
=======================================================================  
Local Bridge  
AP Management  
:Traffic among all client STAs blocked  
:ENABLED  
Ethernet Type Filter :DISABLED  
UPlink Access Table  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------  
UPlink access control:Enabled  
UPlink MAC access control list  
00-12-34-56-78-9a  
:
-----------------------------------------------------------------------  
Enabled Protocol Filters  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------  
No protocol filters are enabled  
=======================================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
206  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
WDS Bridge Commands  
5.15 WDS Bridge Commands  
The WDS Bridge commands are not applicable for the current release.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.16 Spanning Tree Commands  
The Spanning Tree commands are not applicable for the current version.  
208  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ethernet Interface Commands  
5.17 Ethernet Interface Commands  
The commands described in this section configure connection parameters for the  
Ethernet port and wireless interface.  
Table 5-16: Ethernet Interface Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
interface ethernet  
dns primary- server  
dns secondary- server  
ip address  
Enters Ethernet interface configuration mode  
Specifies the primary name server  
Specifies the secondary name server  
Sets the IP address for the Ethernet interface  
Submits a DHCP request for an IP address  
IC-E  
IC-E  
IC-E  
IC-E  
IC-E  
ip dhcp  
speed-duplex  
Configures speed and duplex operation on the Ethernet  
interface  
shutdown  
Disables the Ethernet interface  
IC-E  
show interface ethernet  
Shows the status for the Ethernet interface  
Exec  
5.17.1 interface ethernet  
This command enters Ethernet interface configuration mode.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
To specify the 10/100Base-TX network interface, enter the following command:  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.17.2 dns server  
This command specifies the address for the primary or secondary domain name  
server to be used for name-to-address resolution.  
Syntax  
dns primary-server <server-address>  
dns secondary-server <server-address>  
primary-server - Primary server used for name resolution.  
secondary-server - Secondary server used for name resolution.  
server-address - IP address of domain-name server.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The primary and secondary name servers are queried in sequence.  
Example  
This example specifies two domain-name servers.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#dns primary-server 192.168.1.55  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#dns secondary-server 10.1.0.55  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
Related Commands  
5.17.3 ip address  
This command sets the IP address for the AP. Use the no form to restore the  
default IP address.  
Syntax  
ip address <ip-address> <netmask> <gateway>  
no ip address  
ip-address - IP address  
netmask - Network mask for the associated IP subnet. This mask identifies the host address bits  
used for routing to specific subnets.  
gateway - IP address of the default gateway  
Default Setting  
IP address: 192.168.1.1  
Netmask: 255.255.255.0  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Command Usage  
• DHCP is enabled by default. To manually configure a new IP address, you must first disable the  
DHCP client with the no ip dhcp command.  
• You must assign an IP address to this device to gain management access over the network or to  
connect the AP to existing IP subnets. You can manually configure a specific IP address using  
this command, or direct the device to obtain an address from a DHCP server using the ip dhcp  
command. Valid IP addresses consist of four numbers, 0 to 255, separated by periods. Anything  
outside this format will not be accepted by the configuration program.  
210  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ethernet Interface Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enter Ethernet configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.253  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
Related Commands  
5.17.4 ip dhcp  
This command enables the AP to obtain an IP address from a DHCP server. Use  
the no form to restore the default IP address.  
Syntax  
ip dhcp  
no ip dhcp  
Default Setting  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Command Usage  
• You must assign an IP address to this device to gain management access over the network or to  
connect the AP to existing IP subnets. You can manually configure a specific IP address using  
the ip address command, or direct the device to obtain an address from a DHCP server using  
this command.  
• When you use this command, the AP will begin broadcasting DHCP client requests. The current  
IP address (i.e., default or manually configured address) will continue to be effective until a DHCP  
reply is received. Requests will be broadcast periodically by this device in an effort to learn its IP  
address. (DHCP values can include the IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway.)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface ethernet  
Enter Ethernet configuration commands, one per line.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#ip dhcp  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
Related Commands  
5.17.5 speed-duplex  
This command configures the speed and duplex mode of a given interface when  
autonegotiation is disabled. Use the no form to restore the default.  
Syntax  
speed-duplex <auto | 10MH | 10MF | 100MF | 100MH>  
auto - autonegotiate speed and duplex mode  
10MH - Forces 10 Mbps, half-duplex operation  
10MF - Forces 10 Mbps, full-duplex operation  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
100MH - Forces 100 Mbps, half-duplex operation  
100MF - Forces 100 Mbps, full-duplex operation  
Default Setting  
Auto-negotiation is enabled by default.  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Command Usage  
If autonegotiation is disabled, the speed and duplex mode must be configured to match the setting  
of the attached device.  
Example  
The following example configures the Ethernet port to 100 Mbps, full-duplex  
operation.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#speed-duplex 100mf  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.17.6 shutdown  
This command disables the Ethernet interface. To restart a disabled interface, use  
the no form.  
Syntax  
shutdown  
no shutdown  
Default Setting  
Interface enabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Ethernet)  
Command Usage  
This command allows you to disable the Ethernet port due to abnormal behavior (e.g., excessive  
collisions), and reenable it after the problem has been resolved. You may also want to disable the  
Ethernet port for security reasons.  
Example  
The following example disables the Ethernet port.  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#shutdown  
Enterprise AP(if-ethernet)#  
5.17.7 show interface ethernet  
This command displays the status for the Ethernet interface.  
212  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ethernet Interface Commands  
Syntax  
show interface [ethernet]  
Default Setting  
Ethernet interface  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show interface ethernet  
Ethernet Interface Information  
========================================  
IP Address  
: 192.168.1.1  
: 255.255.255.0  
: 192.168.1.253  
: 192.168.1.55  
: 10.1.0.55  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
Primary DNS  
Secondary DNS  
Speed-duplex  
Admin status  
: 100Base-TX Half Duplex  
: Up  
Operational status : Up  
========================================  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.18 Wireless Interface Commands  
The commands described in this section configure connection parameters for the  
wireless interfaces.  
Table 5-17: Wireless Interface Commands  
Command  
interface wireless  
vap  
Function  
Mode  
Page  
Enters wireless interface configuration mode  
GC  
Provides access to the VAP interface configuration mode IC-W  
speed  
Configures the maximum data rate at which the AP  
transmits unicast packets  
IC-W  
multicast-data-rate  
Configures the maximum rate for transmitting multicast  
packets on the wireless interface  
IC-W  
channel  
Configures the radio channel  
IC-W  
IC-W  
transmit-power  
Adjusts the power of the radio signals transmitted from  
the AP  
radio-mode  
Forces the operating mode of the 802.11g radio  
Sets the length of the 802.11g signal preamble  
Selects the antenna control method to use for the radio  
Selects the antenna ID to use for the radio  
Selects the location of the antenna  
IC-W (b/g)  
IC-W (b/g)  
IC-W  
preamble  
antenna control  
antenna id  
IC-W  
antenna location  
beacon-interval  
IC-W  
Configures the rate at which beacon signals are  
transmitted from the AP  
IC-W  
dtim-period  
Configures the rate at which stations in sleep mode must  
wake up to receive broadcast/multicast transmissions  
IC-W  
IC-W  
IC-W  
fragmentation- length  
rts-threshold  
Configures the minimum packet size that can be  
fragmented  
Sets the packet size threshold at which an RTS must be  
sent to the receiving station prior to the sending station  
starting communications  
super-g  
Enables Atheros proprietary Super G performance  
enhancements  
IC-W (b/g) 224  
description  
ssid  
Adds a description to the wireless interface  
Configures the service set identifier  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W-VAP  
closed system  
max-association  
Opens access to clients without a pre-configured SSID  
Configures the maximum number of clients that can be  
associated with the AP at the same time  
214  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Wireless Interface Commands  
Table 5-17: Wireless Interface Commands  
Function  
Command  
Mode  
Page  
assoc- timeout-interval  
Configures the idle time interval (when no frames are  
sent) after which a client is disassociated from the VAP  
interface  
IC-W-VAP  
auth- timeout-value  
Configures the time interval after which clients must be  
re-authenticated  
IC-W-VAP  
shutdown  
Disables the wireless interface  
IC-W-VAP  
Exec  
show interface wireless  
show station  
Shows the status for the wireless interface  
Shows the wireless clients associated with the AP  
Exec  
5.18.1 interface wireless  
This command enters wireless interface configuration mode.  
Syntax  
interface wireless < g>  
g - 802.11g radio interface.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
To specify the 802.11g interface, enter the following command:  
Enterprise AP(config)#interface wireless g  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.2 vap  
This command provides access to the VAP (Virtual Access Point) interface  
configuration mode.  
Syntax  
vap <vap-id>  
vap-id - The number that identifies the VAP interface. (Options: 0-3)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#vap 0  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
5.18.3 speed  
This command configures the maximum data rate at which the transmits unicast  
packets.  
Syntax  
speed <speed>  
speed - Maximum access speed allowed for wireless clients. (Options for 802.11b/g: 1, 2, 5.5, 6, 9,  
11, 12, 18, 24, 36, 48, 54 Mbps))  
Default Setting  
54 Mbps  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• The maximum transmission distance is affected by the data rate. The lower the data rate, the  
longer the transmission distance. Please refer to the table for maximum distances.  
• When turbo mode is enabled ( page 224), the effective maximum speed specified by this  
command is double the entered value (e.g., setting the speed to 54 Mbps limits the effective  
maximum speed to 108 Mbps).  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#speed 6  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.4 multicast-data-rate  
This command configures the maximum data rate at which the AP transmits  
multicast and management packets (excluding beacon packets) on the wireless  
interface.  
Syntax  
multicast-data-rate <speed>  
speed - Maximum transmit speed allowed for multicast data.  
(Options for 802.11b/g; 1, 2, 5.5, 11 Mbps  
216  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Wireless Interface Commands  
Default Setting  
1 Mbps for 802.11b/g  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#multicast-data-rate 5.5  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.18.5 channel  
This command configures the radio channel through which the AP communicates  
with wireless clients.  
Syntax  
channel <channel | auto>  
channel - Manually sets the radio channel used for communications with wireless clients. (Range for  
802.11b/g: 1 to 14)  
auto - Automatically selects an unoccupied channel (if available). Otherwise, the lowest channel  
is selected.  
Default Setting  
Automatic channel selection  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• The available channel settings are limited by local regulations, which determine the number of  
channels that are available.  
• When multiple APs are deployed in the same area, be sure to choose channels separated by at  
least four channels from each other . You can deploy up to three APs in the same area for  
802.11b/g (e.g., channels 1, 6, 11).  
• When using Turbo Mode (Super G enabled), select channel 6.  
For most wireless adapters, the channel for wireless clients is automatically set to the same as that  
used by the AP to which it is linked.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#channel 1  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.6 transmit-power  
This command adjusts the power of the radio signals transmitted from the AP.  
Syntax  
transmit-power <signal-strength>  
signal-strength - Signal strength transmitted from the AP. (Options: full, half, quarter, eighth,  
min)  
Default Setting  
full  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• The “min” keyword indicates minimum power.  
• The longer the transmission distance, the higher the transmission power required. But to support  
the maximum number of users in an area, you must keep the power as low as possible. Power  
selection is not just a trade off between coverage area and maximum supported clients. You also  
have to ensure that high strength signals do not interfere with the operation of other radio devices  
in your area.  
218  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Wireless Interface Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#transmit-power half  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.7 radio-mode  
This command forces the operating mode for the 802.11g wireless interface.  
Syntax  
radio-mode <b | g | b+g>  
b - b-only mode: Both 802.11b and 802.11g clients can communicate with the AP, but 802.11g  
clients can only transfer data at 802.11b standard rates (up to 11 Mbps).  
g - g-only mode: Only 802.11g clients can communicate with the AP (up to 54 Mbps).  
b+g - b & g mixed mode: Both 802.11b and 802.11g clients can communicate with the AP (up to  
54 Mbps).  
Default Setting  
b+g mode  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless - 802.11g)  
Command Usage  
• For Japan, only 13 channels are available when set to g or b+g modes. When set to b mode, 14  
channels are available.  
• Both the 802.11g and 802.11b standards operate within the 2.4 GHz band. If you are operating  
in g mode, any 802.11b devices in the service area will contribute to the radio frequency noise  
and affect network performance.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#radio-mode g  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.8 preamble  
This command sets the length of the signal preamble that is used at the start of a  
802.11b/g data transmission.  
Syntax  
preamble [long | short-or-long]  
long - Sets the preamble to long (192 microseconds).  
short-or-long - Sets the preamble to short if no 802.11b clients are detected (96 microseconds).  
Default Setting  
Short-or-Long  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless - 802.11b/g)  
Command Usage  
• Using a short preamble instead of a long preamble can increase data throughput on the AP, but  
requires that all clients can support a short preamble.  
• Set the preamble to long to ensure the AP can support all 802.11b and 802.11g clients.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#preamble short  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.9 antenna control  
This command selects the use of two diversity antennas or a single antenna for  
the radio interface.  
Syntax  
antenna control <diversity | left | right>  
diversity - The radio uses two identical antennas in a diversity mode.  
left - The radio uses a single antenna on the left side. Select this method when using an optional  
external antenna that is connected to the left antenna connector.  
right - The radio uses a single antenna on the right side. Select this method when using an  
optional external antenna that is connected to the right antenna connector.  
Default Setting  
Diversity  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
The antenna ID must be selected in conjunction with the antenna control method to configure  
proper use of any of the antenna options.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#antenna control right  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.10 antenna id  
This command specifies the antenna type connected to the AP represented by a  
four-digit hexadecimal ID number.  
Syntax  
antenna id <antenna-id>  
antenna-id - Specifies the ID number of an approved antenna that is connected to the AP  
(Range: 0x0000 - 0xFFFF)  
Default Setting  
0x0000 (None). The unit will not transmit until an antenna is defined  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• The optional external antennas (if any) that are certified for use with the AP are listed by typing  
antenna control id ?. Selecting the correct antenna ID ensures that the AP's radio transmissions  
are within regulatory power limits for the country of operation.  
• The antenna ID must be selected in conjunction with the antenna control method to configure  
proper use of any of the antenna options.  
220  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Wireless Interface Commands  
• In the current release, select id=0x0108 for the 8dBi omni antenna.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#antenna id 0000  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.11 antenna location  
This command selects the antenna mounting location for the radio interface.  
Syntax  
antenna location <indoor | outdoor>  
indoor - The antenna is mounted indoors.  
outdoor - The antenna is mounted outdoors.  
Default Setting  
Indoor  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• Selecting the correct location ensures that the AP only uses radio channels that are permitted in  
the country of operation.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#antenna location indoor  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.12 beacon-interval  
This command configures the rate at which beacon signals are transmitted from  
the AP.  
Syntax  
beacon-interval <interval>  
interval - The rate for transmitting beacon signals. (Range: 20-1000 milliseconds)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
100  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
The beacon signals allow wireless clients to maintain contact with the AP. They may also carry  
power-management information.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#beacon-interval 150  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.13 dtim-period  
This command configures the rate at which stations in sleep mode must wake up  
to receive broadcast/multicast transmissions.  
Syntax  
dtim-period <interval>  
interval - Interval between the beacon frames that transmit broadcast or multicast traffic.  
(Range: 1-255 beacon frames)  
Default Setting  
1
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• The Delivery Traffic Indication Map (DTIM) packet interval value indicates how often the MAC  
layer forwards broadcast/multicast traffic. This parameter is necessary to wake up stations that  
are using Power Save mode.  
• The DTIM is the interval between two synchronous frames with broadcast/multicast information.  
The default value of 2 indicates that the AP will save all broadcast/multicast frames for the Basic  
Service Set (BSS) and forward them after every second beacon.  
• Using smaller DTIM intervals delivers broadcast/multicast frames in a more timely manner,  
causing stations in Power Save mode to wake up more often and drain power faster. Using higher  
DTIM values reduces the power used by stations in Power Save mode, but delays the  
transmission of broadcast/multicast frames.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#dtim-period 100  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.14 fragmentation-length  
This command configures the minimum packet size that can be fragmented when  
passing through the AP.  
222  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Wireless Interface Commands  
Syntax  
fragmentation-length <length>  
length - Minimum packet size for which fragmentation is allowed. (Range: 256-2346 bytes)  
Default Setting  
2346  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• If the packet size is smaller than the preset Fragment size, the packet will not be segmented.  
• Fragmentation of the PDUs (Package Data Unit) can increase the reliability of transmissions  
because it increases the probability of a successful transmission due to smaller frame size. If  
there is significant interference present, or collisions due to high network utilization, try setting the  
fragment size to send smaller fragments. This will speed up the retransmission of smaller frames.  
However, it is more efficient to set the fragment size larger if very little or no interference is present  
because it requires overhead to send multiple frames.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#fragmentation-length 512  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.15 rts-threshold  
This command sets the packet size threshold at which a Request to Send (RTS)  
signal must be sent to the receiving station prior to the sending station starting  
communications.  
Syntax  
rts-threshold <threshold>  
threshold - Threshold packet size for which to send an RTS. (Range: 0-2347 bytes)  
Default Setting  
2347  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• If the threshold is set to 0, the AP always sends RTS signals. If set to 2347, the AP never sends  
RTS signals. If set to any other value, and the packet size equals or exceeds the RTS threshold,  
the RTS/CTS (Request to Send / Clear to Send) mechanism will be enabled.  
• The AP sends RTS frames to a receiving station to negotiate the sending of a data frame. After  
receiving an RTS frame, the station sends a CTS frame to notify the sending station that it can  
start sending data.  
• APs contending for the wireless medium may not be aware of each other. The RTS/CTS  
mechanism can solve this “Hidden Node” problem.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rts-threshold 256  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.16 super-g  
This command enables Atheros proprietary Super G performance enhancements.  
Use the no form to disable this function.  
Syntax  
[no] super-g  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless - 802.11g)  
Command Usage  
These enhancements include bursting, compression, fast frames and dynamic turbo. Maximum  
throughput ranges between 40 to 60 Mbps for connections to Atheros-compatible clients.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#super g  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.17 description  
This command adds a description to a the wireless interface. Use the no form to  
remove the description.  
Syntax  
description <string>  
no description  
string - Comment or a description for this interface.  
(Range: 1-80 characters)  
Default Setting  
Radio G: Enterprise 802.11g Access Point  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#description RD-AP#3  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
5.18.18 ssid  
This command configures the service set identifier (SSID).  
224  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Wireless Interface Commands  
Syntax  
ssid <string>  
string - The name of a basic service set supported by the AP. (Range: 0 - 7 characters)  
Default Setting  
802.11g Radio: VAP_TEST_11G (0 to 3)  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
Clients that want to connect to the wireless network via an AP must set their SSIDs to the same  
as that of the AP.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#ssid RD-AP#3  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.19 closed-system  
This command prohibits access to clients without a pre-configured SSID. Use the  
no form to disable this feature.  
Syntax  
closed-system  
no closed-system  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
When closed system is enabled, the AP will not include its SSID in beacon messages. Nor will it  
respond to probe requests from clients that do not include a fixed SSID.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#closed-system  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.20 max-association  
This command configures the maximum number of clients that can be associated  
with the AP at the same time.  
Syntax  
max-association <count>  
count - Maximum number of associated stations. (Range: 0-64)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
64  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#max-association 32  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.21 assoc-timeout-interval  
This command configures the idle time interval (when no frames are sent) after  
which the client is disassociated from the VAP interface.  
Syntax  
assoc-timeout-interval <minutes>  
minutes - The number of minutes of inactivity before disassociation. (Range: 5-60)  
Default Setting  
30  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#association-timeout-interval 20  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
5.18.22 auth-timeout-value  
This command configures the time interval within which clients must complete  
authentication to the VAP interface.  
Syntax  
auth-timeout-value <minutes>  
minutes - The number of minutes before re-authentication. (Range: 5-60)  
Default Setting  
60  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#auth-timeout-value 40  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
5.18.23 shutdown  
This command disables the wireless interface. Use the no form to restart the  
interface.  
226  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Wireless Interface Commands  
Syntax  
shutdown  
no shutdown  
Default Setting  
Interface enabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
You must first enable VAP interface 0 before you can enable VAP interfaces 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#shutdown  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.18.24 show interface wireless  
This command displays the status for the wireless interface.  
Syntax  
show interface wireless < g> vap-id  
g - 802.11g radio interface.  
vap-id - The number that identifies the VAP interface. (Options: 0~3)  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show interface wireless g 0  
Wireless Interface Information  
=========================================================================  
----------------Identification-------------------------------------------  
Description  
SSID  
Channel  
: Enterprise 802.11g Access Point  
: VAP_TEST_11G 0  
: 1 (AUTO)  
Status  
: ENABLED  
MAC Address  
: 00:03:7f:fe:03:02  
----------------802.11 Parameters----------------------------------------  
Radio Mode  
Protection Method  
Transmit Power  
Max Station Data Rate  
Multicast Data Rate  
Fragmentation Threshold  
RTS Threshold  
: b & g mixed mode  
: CTS only  
: FULL (16 dBm)  
: 54Mbps  
: 5.5Mbps  
: 2346 bytes  
: 2347 bytes  
: 100 TUs  
Beacon Interval  
Authentication Timeout Interval : 60 Mins  
Association Timeout Interval  
DTIM Interval  
Preamble Length  
Maximum Association  
MIC Mode  
: 30 Mins  
: 1 beacon  
: LONG  
: 64 stations  
: Software  
: Disabled  
: 1  
Super G  
VLAN ID  
----------------Security-------------------------------------------------  
Closed System  
: Disabled  
: WEP  
Multicast cipher  
Unicast cipher  
WPA clients  
WPA Key Mgmt Mode  
WPA PSK Key Type  
WPA PSK Key  
: TKIP and AES  
: DISABLED  
: PRE SHARED KEY  
: PASSPHRASE  
: EMPTY  
PMKSA Lifetime  
Encryption  
: 720 minutes  
: ENABLED  
Default Transmit Key  
Common Static Keys  
: 1  
: Key 1: EMPTY  
Key 3: EMPTY  
: DISABLED  
: SHARED  
Key 2: EMPTY  
Key 4: EMPTY  
Pre-Authentication  
Authentication Type  
228  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wireless Interface Commands  
----------------802.1x---------------------------------------------------  
802.1x  
: DISABLED  
: 30 min  
: 30 min  
: 0 min  
Broadcast Key Refresh Rate  
Session Key Refresh Rate  
802.1x Session Timeout Value  
----------------Antenna--------------------------------------------------  
Antenna Control method  
Antenna ID  
Antenna Location  
: Diversity  
: 0x0000(Default Antenna)  
: Indoor  
----------------Quality of Service---------------------------------------  
WMM Mode  
: SUPPORTED  
WMM Acknowledge Policy  
AC0(Best Effort)  
AC1(Background)  
AC2(Video)  
: Acknowledge  
: Acknowledge  
: Acknowledge  
: Acknowledge  
AC3(Voice)  
WMM BSS Parameters  
AC0(Best Effort)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 10 AIFSN: 3  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
AC1(Background)  
AC2(Video)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 10 AIFSN: 7  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
: logCwMin: 3 logCwMax: 4 AIFSN: 2  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 3.008 ms  
AC3(Voice)  
: logCwMin: 2 logCwMax: 3 AIFSN: 2  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 1.504 ms  
WMM AP Parameters  
AC0(Best Effort)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 6 AIFSN: 3  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
AC1(Background)  
AC2(Video)  
: logCwMin: 4 logCwMax: 10 AIFSN: 7  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 0.000 ms  
: logCwMin: 3 logCwMax: 4 AIFSN: 1  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 3.008 ms  
AC3(Voice)  
: logCwMin: 2 logCwMax: 3 AIFSN: 1  
Admission Control: No  
TXOP Limit: 1.504 ms  
=========================================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
5.18.25 show station  
This command shows the wireless clients associated with the AP.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show station  
Station Table Information  
========================================================  
if-wireless g VAP [0] :  
802.11g Channel : 60  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
.
.
.
if-wireless G VAP [0] :  
802.11g Channel : 1  
802.11g Channel Station Table  
Station Address : 00-04-23-94-9A-9C VLAN ID: 0  
Authenticated Associated  
TRUE FALSE  
Forwarding  
FALSE  
KeyType  
NONE  
Counters:pkts Tx / Rx  
20/  
bytes Tx / Rx  
721/  
0
0
Time:Associated LastAssoc LastDisAssoc LastAuth  
0
0
0
0
if-wireless G VAP [1] :  
802.11g Channel : 1  
No 802.11g Channel Stations.  
.
.
.
Enterprise AP#  
230  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rogue AP Detection Commands  
5.19 Rogue AP Detection Commands  
A “rogue AP” is either an AP that is not authorized to participate in the wireless  
network, or an AP that does not have the correct security configuration. Rogue  
APs can potentially allow unauthorized users access to the network. Alternatively,  
client stations may mistakenly associate to a rogue AP and be prevented from  
accessing network resources. Rogue APs may also cause radio interference and  
degrade the wireless LAN performance.  
The AP can be configured to periodically scan all radio channels and find other  
APs within range. A database of nearby APs is maintained where any rogue APs  
can be identified.  
Table 5-18: Rogue AP Detection Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
233  
rogue-ap enable  
rogue-ap authenticate  
rogue-ap duration  
rogue-ap interval  
rogue-ap scan  
Enables the periodic detection of other nearby APs  
Enables identification of all APs  
GC  
Sets the duration that all channels are scanned  
Sets the time between each scan  
GC  
GC  
Forces an immediate scan of all radio channels  
Shows the current database of detected APs  
GC  
show rogue-ap  
Exec  
5.19.1 rogue-ap enable  
This command enables the periodic detection of nearby APs. Use the no form to  
disable periodic detection.  
Syntax  
[no] rogue-ap enable  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• While the AP scans a channel for rogue APs, wireless clients will not be able to connect to the  
AP. Therefore, avoid frequent scanning or scans of a long duration unless there is a reason to  
believe that more intensive scanning is required to find a rogue AP.  
• A “rogue AP” is either an AP that is not authorized to participate in the wireless network, or an AP  
that does not have the correct security configuration. Rogue APs can be identified by unknown  
BSSID (MAC address) or SSID configuration. A database of nearby sh  
• s should therefore be maintained on a RADIUS server, allowing any rogue APs to be identified  
(see “rogue-ap authenticate” on page 232). The rogue AP database can be viewed using  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
the show rogue-ap command.  
• The AP sends Syslog messages for each detected AP during a rogue AP scan.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap enable  
configure either syslog or trap or both to receive the rogue APs detected.  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.19.2 rogue-ap authenticate  
This command forces the unit to authenticate all APs on the network. Use the no  
form to disable this function.  
Syntax  
[no] rogue-ap authenticate  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
Enabling authentication in conjunction with a database of approved APs stored on a RADIUS  
server allows the AP to discover rogue APs. With authentication enabled and a configure RADIUS  
server, the AP checks the MAC address/Basic Service Set Identifier (BSSID) of each AP that it  
finds against a RADIUS server to determine whether the AP is allowed. With authentication  
disabled, the AP can identify its neighboring APs only; it cannot identify whether the APs are  
allowed or are rogues. If you enable authentication, you should also configure a RADIUS server  
for this AP (see “RADIUS” on page 52).  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap authenticate  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.19.3 rogue-ap duration  
This command sets the scan duration for detecting APs.  
Syntax  
rogue-ap duration <milliseconds>  
milliseconds - The duration of the scan. (Range: 100-1000 milliseconds)  
Default Setting  
350 milliseconds  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• During a scan, client access may be disrupted and new clients may not be able to associate to  
the AP. If clients experience severe disruption, reduce the scan duration time.  
• A long scan duration time will detect more APs in the area, but causes more disruption to client  
access.  
232  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Rogue AP Detection Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap duration 200  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
Related Commands  
5.19.4 rogue-ap interval  
This command sets the interval at which to scan for APs.  
Syntax  
rogue-ap interval <minutes>  
minutes - The interval between consecutive scans. (Range: 30-10080 minutes)  
Default Setting  
720 minutes  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
This command sets the interval at which scans occur. Frequent scanning will more readily detect  
other APs, but will cause more disruption to client access.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap interval 120  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
Related Commands  
5.19.5 rogue-ap scan  
This command starts an immediate scan for APs on the radio interface.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
While the AP scans a channel for rogue APs, wireless clients will not be able to connect to the AP.  
Therefore, avoid frequent scanning or scans of a long duration unless there is a reason to believe  
that more intensive scanning is required to find a rogue AP.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogue-ap scan  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#rogueApDetect Completed (Radio G) : 9 APs detected  
rogueAPDetect (Radio G): refreshing ap database now  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.19.6 show rogue-ap  
This command displays the current rogue AP database.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show rogue-ap  
802.11g Channel : Rogue AP Status  
AP Address(BSSID)  
SSID Channel(MHz) RSSI Type Privacy RSN  
======================================================================  
00-04-e2-2a-37-23  
00-04-e2-2a-37-3d  
00-04-e2-2a-37-49  
00-90-d1-08-9d-a7  
00-30-f1-fb-31-f4  
Enterprise AP#  
WLAN1AP 11(2462 MHz) 17 ESS  
0 0  
0 0  
0 0  
0 0  
0 0  
ANY  
WLAN1AP  
WLAN1AP  
WLAN  
7(2442 MHz) 42 ESS  
9(2452 MHz) 42 ESS  
1(2412 MHz) 12 ESS  
6(2437 MHz) 16 ESS  
234  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Wireless Security Commands  
5.20 Wireless Security Commands  
The commands described in this section configure parameters for wireless  
security on the 802.11g interface.  
Table 5-19: Wireless Security Commands  
Command  
auth  
Function  
Mode  
Page  
Defines the 802.11 authentication type allowed by the AP IC-W-VAP  
encryption  
Defines whether or not WEP encryption is used to  
provide privacy for wireless communications  
IC-W-VAP  
key  
Sets the keys used for WEP encryption  
IC-W  
transmit-key  
Sets the index of the key to be used for encrypting data  
frames sent between the AP and wireless clients  
IC-W-VAP  
cipher-suite  
mic_mode  
Selects an encryption method for the global key used for  
multicast and broadcast traffic  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W  
Specifies how to calculate the Message Integrity Check  
(MIC)  
wpa-pre-shared- key  
pmksa-lifetime  
Defines a WPA preshared-key value  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W-VAP  
IC-W-VAP  
Sets the lifetime PMK security associations  
Enables WPA2 pre-authentication for fast roaming  
pre-authentication  
5.20.1 auth  
This command configures authentication for the VAP interface.  
Syntax  
auth <open-system | shared-key | wpa | wpa-psk | wpa2 | wpa2-psk | wpa-wpa2-mixed |  
wpa-wpa2-psk-mixed | > <required | supported>  
open-system - Accepts the client without verifying its identity using a shared key. “Open”  
authentication means either there is no encryption (if encryption is disabled) or WEP-only  
encryption is used (if encryption is enabled).  
shared-key - Authentication is based on a shared key that has been distributed to all stations.  
wpa - Clients using WPA are accepted for authentication.  
wpa-psk - Clients using WPA with a Pre-shared Key are accepted for authentication.  
wpa2 - Clients using WPA2 are accepted for authentication.  
wpa2-psk - Clients using WPA2 with a Pre-shared Key are accepted for authentication.  
wpa-wpa2-mixed - Clients using WPA or WPA2 are accepted for authentication.  
wpa-wpa2-psk-mixed - Clients using WPA or WPA2 with a Pre-shared Key are accepted for  
authentication  
required - Clients are required to use WPA or WPA2.  
supported - Clients may use WPA or WPA2, if supported.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
open-system  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• The auth command automatically configures settings for each authentication type, including  
encryption, 802.1X, and cipher suite. The command auth open-system disables encryption and  
802.1X.  
• To use WEP shared-key authentication, set the authentication type to “shared-key” and define at  
least one static WEP key with the key command. Encryption is automatically enabled by the  
command.  
• To use WEP encryption only (no authentication), set the authentication type to “open-system.”  
Then enable WEP with the encryption command, and define at least one static WEP key with  
the key command.  
• When any WPA or WPA2 option is selected, clients are authenticated using 802.1X via a RADIUS  
server. Each client must be WPA-enabled or support 802.1X client software. The 802.1X settings  
(see “802.1X Authentication” on page 195) and RADIUS server details (see “RADIUS  
Client” on page 189) must be configured on the AP. A RADIUS server must also be  
configured and be available in the wired network.  
• If a WPA/WPA2 mode that operates over 802.1X is selected (WPA, WPA2, WPA-WPA2-mixed,  
or WPA-WPA2-PSK-mixed), the 802.1X settings (see “802.1X Authentication” on  
page 195) and RADIUS server details (see “RADIUS Client” on page 189) must be  
configured. Be sure you have also configured a RADIUS server on the network before enabling  
authentication. Also, note that each client has to be WPA-enabled or support 802.1X client  
software. A RADIUS server must also be configured and be available in the wired network.  
• If a WPA/WPA2 Pre-shared Key mode is selected (WPA-PSK, WPA2-PSK or  
WPA-WPA2-PSK-mixed), the key must first be generated and distributed to all wireless clients  
before they can successfully associate with the AP. Use the wpa-preshared-key command to  
• WPA2 defines a transitional mode of operation for networks moving from WPA security to WPA2.  
WPA2 Mixed Mode allows both WPA and WPA2 clients to associate to a common VAP interface.  
When the encryption cipher suite is set to TKIP, the unicast encryption cipher (TKIP or  
AES-CCMP) is negotiated for each client. The AP advertises it’s supported encryption ciphers in  
beacon frames and probe responses. WPA and WPA2 clients select the cipher they support and  
return the choice in the association request to the . For mixed-mode operation, the cipher used  
for broadcast frames is always TKIP. WEP encryption is not allowed.  
• The “required” option places the VAP into TKIP only mode. The “supported” option places the  
VAP into TKIP+AES+WEP mode. The “required” mode is used in WPA-only environments.  
• The “supported” mode can be used for mixed environments with legacy WPA products,  
specifically WEP. (For example, WPA+WEP. The WPA2+WEP environment is not available  
because WPA2 does not support WEP). To place the VAP into AES only mode, use “required”  
and then select the “cipher-ccmp” option for the cipher-suite command.  
236  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Wireless Security Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#auth shared-key  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
Related Commands  
5.20.2 encryption  
This command enables data encryption for wireless communications. Use the no  
form to disable data encryption.  
Syntax  
encryption  
no encryption  
Default Setting  
disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) is implemented in this device to prevent unauthorized access to  
your wireless network. For more secure data transmissions, enable encryption with this  
command, and set at least one static WEP key with the key command.  
• The WEP settings must be the same on each client in your wireless network.  
• Note that WEP protects data transmitted between wireless nodes, but does not protect any  
transmissions over your wired network or over the Internet.  
• You must enable data encryption in order to enable all types of encryption (WEP, TKIP, and  
AES-CCMP) in the AP.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#encryption  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
Related Commands  
5.20.3 key  
This command sets the keys used for WEP encryption. Use the no form to delete a  
configured key.  
Syntax  
key <index> <size> <type> <value>  
no key index  
index - Key index. (Range: 1-4)  
size - Key size. (Options: 64, 128, or 152 bits)  
type - Input format. (Options: ASCII, HEX)  
value - The key string.  
- For 64-bit keys, use 5 alphanumeric characters or 10 hexadecimal digits.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
- For 128-bit keys, use 13 alphanumeric characters or 26 hexadecimal digits.  
- For 152-bit keys, use 16 alphanumeric characters or 32 hexadecimal digits.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• To enable Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP), use the auth shared-key command to select the  
“shared key” authentication type, use the key command to configure at least one key, and use  
the transmit-key command to assign a key to one of the VAP interfaces.  
• If WEP option is enabled, all wireless clients must be configured with the same shared keys to  
communicate with the AP.  
• The encryption index, length and type configured in the AP must match those configured in the  
clients.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#key 1 64 hex 1234512345  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#key 2 128 ascii asdeipadjsipd  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#key 3 64 hex 12345123451234512345123456  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
Related Commands  
5.20.4 transmit-key  
This command sets the index of the key to be used for encrypting data frames for  
broadcast or multicast traffic transmitted from the VAP to wireless clients.  
Syntax  
transmit-key <index>  
index - Key index. (Range: 1-4)  
Default Setting  
1
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• If you use WEP key encryption option, the AP uses the transmit key to encrypt multicast and  
broadcast data signals that it sends to client devices. Other keys can be used for decryption of  
data from clients.  
• When using IEEE 802.1X, the AP uses a dynamic key to encrypt unicast and broadcast  
messages to 802.1X-enabled clients. However, because the AP sends the keys during the  
802.1X authentication process, these keys do not have to appear in the client’s key list.  
• In a mixed-mode environment with clients using static and dynamic keys, select transmit key  
index 2, 3, or 4. The AP uses transmit key index 1 for the generation of dynamic keys.  
238  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Wireless Security Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#transmit-key 2  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.20.5 cipher-suite  
This command defines the cipher algorithm used to encrypt the global key for  
broadcast and multicast traffic when using WiFi Protected Access (WPA) security.  
Syntax  
multicast-cipher <aes-ccmp | tkip | wep>  
aes-ccmp - Use AES-CCMP encryption for the unicast and multicast cipher.  
tkip - Use TKIP encryption for the multicast cipher. TKIP or AES-CCMP can be used for the  
unicast cipher depending on the capability of the client.  
wep - Use WEP encryption for the multicast cipher. TKIP or AES-CCMP can be used for the  
unicast cipher depending on the capability of the client.  
Default Setting  
wep  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• WPA enables the AP to support different unicast encryption keys for each client. However, the  
global encryption key for multicast and broadcast traffic must be the same for all clients.  
• If any clients supported by the AP are not WPA enabled, the multicast-cipher algorithm must be  
set to WEP.  
• WEP is the first generation security protocol used to encrypt data crossing the wireless medium  
using a fairly short key. Communicating devices must use the same WEP key to encrypt and  
decrypt radio signals. WEP has many security flaws, and is not recommended for transmitting  
highly sensitive data.  
• TKIP provides data encryption enhancements including per-packet key hashing (i.e., changing  
the encryption key on each packet), a message integrity check, an extended initialization vector  
with sequencing rules, and a re-keying mechanism. Select TKIP if there are clients in the network  
that are not WPA2 compliant.  
• TKIP defends against attacks on WEP in which the unencrypted initialization vector in encrypted  
packets is used to calculate the WEP key. TKIP changes the encryption key on each packet, and  
rotates not just the unicast keys, but the broadcast keys as well. TKIP is a replacement for WEP  
that removes the predictability that intruders relied on to determine the WEP key.  
• AES-CCMP (Advanced Encryption Standard Counter-Mode/CBCMAC Protocol): WPA2 is  
backward compatible with WPA, including the same 802.1X and PSK modes of operation and  
support for TKIP encryption. The main enhancement is its use of AES Counter-Mode encryption  
with Cipher Block Chaining Message Authentication Code (CBC-MAC) for message integrity. The  
AES Counter-Mode/CBCMAC Protocol (AES-CCMP) provides extremely robust data  
confidentiality using a 128-bit key. The AES-CCMP encryption cipher is specified as a standard  
requirement for WPA2. However, the computational intensive operations of AES-CCMP requires  
hardware support on client devices. Therefore to implement WPA2 in the network, wireless  
clients must be upgraded to WPA2-compliant hardware.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#multicast-cipher TKIP  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.20.6 mic_mode  
This command specifies how to calculate the Message Integrity Check (MIC).  
Syntax  
mic_mode <hardware | software>  
hardware - Uses hardware to calculate the MIC.  
software - Uses software to calculate the MIC.  
Default Setting  
software  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• The Michael Integrity Check (MIC) is part of the Temporal Key Integrity Protocol (TKIP)  
encryption used in WiFi Protected Access (WPA) security. The MIC calculation is performed in  
the AP for each transmitted packet and this can impact throughput and performance. The AP  
supports a choice of hardware or software for MIC calculation. The performance of the AP can  
be improved by selecting the best method for the specific deployment.  
• Using the “hardware” option provides best performance when the number of supported clients is  
less than 27.  
• Using the “software” option provides the best performance for a large number of clients on one  
radio interface. Throughput may be reduced when the 802.11g interface supports a high number of  
clients simultaneously.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#mic_mode hardware  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.20.7 wpa-pre-shared-key  
This command defines a WiFi Protected Access (WPA/WPA2) Pre-shared-key.  
Syntax  
wpa-pre-shared-key <hex | passphrase-key> <value>  
hex - Specifies hexadecimal digits as the key input format.  
passphrase-key - Specifies an ASCII pass-phrase string as the key input format.  
value - The key string. For ASCII input, specify a string between 8 and 63 characters. For HEX  
input, specify exactly 64 digits.  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• To support WPA or WPA2 for client authentication, use the auth command to specify the  
authentication type, and use the wpa-preshared-key command to specify one static key.  
• If WPA or WPA2 is used with pre-shared-key mode, all wireless clients must be configured with  
the same pre-shared key to communicate with the AP’s VAP interface.  
240  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Wireless Security Commands  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#wpa-pre-shared-key ASCII agoodsecret  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
Related Commands  
5.20.8 pmksa-lifetime  
This command sets the time for aging out cached WPA2 Pairwise Master Key  
Security Association (PMKSA) information for fast roaming.  
Syntax  
pmksa-lifetime <minutes>  
minutes - The time for aging out PMKSA information. (Range: 0 - 14400 minutes)  
Default Setting  
720 minutes  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• WPA2 provides fast roaming for authenticated clients by retaining keys and other security  
information in a cache, so that if a client roams away from an AP and then returns  
reauthentication is not required.  
• When a WPA2 client is first authenticated, it receives a Pairwise Master Key (PMK) that is used  
to generate other keys for unicast data encryption. This key and other client information form a  
Security Association that the AP names and holds in a cache. The lifetime of this security  
association can be configured with this command. When the lifetime expires, the client security  
association and keys are deleted from the cache. If the client returns to the AP, it requires full  
reauthentication.  
• The AP can store up to 256 entries in the PMKSA cache.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#wpa-pre-shared-key ASCII agoodsecret  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
5.20.9 pre-authentication  
This command enables WPA2 pre-authentication for fast secure roaming.  
Syntax  
pre-authentication <enable | disable>  
enable - Enables pre-authentication for the VAP interface.  
disable - Disables pre-authentication for the VAP interface.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• Each time a client roams to another AP it has to be fully re-authenticated. This authentication  
process is time consuming and can disrupt applications running over the network. WPA2 includes  
a mechanism, known as pre-authentication, that allows clients to roam to a new AP and be  
quickly associated. The first time a client is authenticated to a wireless network it has to be fully  
authenticated. When the client is about to roam to another AP in the network, the AP sends  
pre-authentication messages to the new AP that include the client’s security association  
information. Then when the client sends an association request to the new AP, the client is known  
to be already authenticated, so it proceeds directly to key exchange and association.  
• To support pre-authentication, both clients and APs in the network must be WPA2 enabled.  
• Pre-authentication requires all APs in the network to be on the same IP subnet.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#wpa-pre-shared-key ASCII agoodsecret  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
242  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Link Integrity Commands  
5.21 Link Integrity Commands  
The AP provides a link integrity feature that can be used to ensure that wireless  
clients are connected to resources on the wired network. The AP does this by  
periodically sending Ping messages to a host device in the wired Ethernet  
network. If the AP detects that the connection to the host has failed, it disables  
the radio interfaces, forcing clients to find and associate with another AP. When  
the connection to the host is restored, the AP re-enables the radio interfaces.  
Table 5-20: Link Integrity Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
link-integrity ping-detect  
link-integrity ping-host  
Enables link integrity detection  
Specifies the IP address of a host device in the wired  
network  
GC  
link-integrity ping-interval  
link-integrity ping-fail-retry  
Specifies the time between each Ping sent to the link  
host  
GC  
GC  
Specifies the number of consecutive failed Ping  
counts before the link is determined as lost  
link-integrity ethernet-detect  
show link-integrity  
Enables integrity check for Ethernet link  
GC  
Displays the current link integrity configuration  
Exec  
5.21.1 link-integrity ping-detect  
This command enables link integrity detection. Use the no form to disable link  
integrity detection.  
Syntax  
[no] link-integrity ping-detect  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
• When link integrity is enabled, the IP address of a host device in the wired network must be  
specified.  
• The AP periodically sends an ICMP echo request (Ping) packet to the link host IP address. When  
the number of failed responses (either the host does not respond or is unreachable) exceeds the  
limit set by the link-integrity ping-fail-retry command, the link is determined as lost.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#link-integrity ping-detect  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.21.2 link-integrity ping-host  
This command configures the link host name or IP address. Use the no form to  
remove the host setting.  
Syntax  
link-integrity ping-host <host_name | ip_address>  
no link-integrity ping-host  
host_name - Alias of the host.  
ip_address - IP address of the host.  
Default Setting  
None  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#link-integrity ping-host 192.168.1.10  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.21.3 link-integrity ping-interval  
This command configures the time between each Ping sent to the link host.  
Syntax  
link-integrity ping-interval <interval>  
interval - The time between Pings. (Range: 5 - 60 seconds)  
Default Setting  
30 seconds  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#link-integrity ping-interval 20  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.21.4 link-integrity ping-fail-retry  
This command configures the number of consecutive failed Ping counts before the  
link is determined as lost.  
Syntax  
link-integrity ping-fail-retry <counts>  
counts - The number of failed Ping counts before the link is determined as lost. (Range: 1 - 10)  
244  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Link Integrity Commands  
Default Setting  
6
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#link-integrity ping-fail-retry 10  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.21.5 link-integrity ethernet-detect  
This command enables an integrity check to determine whether or not the AP is  
connected to the wired Ethernet.  
Syntax  
[no] link-integrity ethernet-detect  
Default Setting  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#link-integrity ethernet-detect  
Notification : Ethernet Link Detect SUCCESS - RADIO(S) ENABLED  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
5.21.6 show link-integrity  
This command displays the current link integrity configuration.  
Command Mode  
Exec  
Example  
Enterprise AP#show link-integrity  
Link Integrity Information  
===========================================================  
Ethernet Detect : Enabled  
Ping Detect  
: Enabled  
Target IP/Name : 192.168.0.140  
Ping Fail Retry : 6  
Ping Interval : 30  
===========================================================  
Enterprise AP#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.22 IAPP Commands  
The command described in this section enables the protocol signaling required to  
ensure the successful handover of wireless clients roaming between different  
802.11f-compliant APs. In other words, the 802.11f protocol can ensure  
successful roaming between APs in a multi-vendor environment.  
5.22.1 iapp  
This command enables the protocol signaling required to hand over wireless  
clients roaming between different 802.11f-compliant APs. Use the no form to  
disable 802.11f signaling.  
Syntax  
[no] iapp  
Default  
Enabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The current 802.11 standard does not specify the signaling required between APs in order to  
support clients roaming from one AP to another. In particular, this can create a problem for clients  
roaming between APs from different vendors. This command is used to enable or disable 802.11f  
handover signaling between different APs, especially in a multi-vendor environment.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#iapp  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
246  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
VLAN Commands  
5.23 VLAN Commands  
The AP can enable the support of VLAN-tagged traffic passing between wireless  
clients and the wired network. Up to 64 VLAN IDs can be mapped to specific  
wireless clients, allowing users to remain within the same VLAN as they move  
around a campus site.  
When VLAN is enabled on the AP, a VLAN ID (a number between 1 and 4094) can  
be assigned to each client after successful authentication using IEEE 802.1X and  
a central RADIUS server. The user VLAN IDs must be configured on the RADIUS  
server for each user authorized to access the network. If a user does not have a  
configured VLAN ID, the AP assigns the user to its own configured native VLAN  
ID.  
CAUTION  
When VLANs are enabled, the AP’s Ethernet port drops all received traffic that does not include a  
VLAN tag. To maintain network connectivity to the AP and wireless clients, be sure that the AP is  
connected to a device port on a wired network that supports IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tags.  
The VLAN commands supported by the AP are listed below.  
Table 5-21: VLAN Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
GC  
Page  
vlan  
Enables a single VLAN for all traffic  
Configures the management VLAN for the AP  
management-  
vlanid  
GC  
vlan-id  
Configures the default VLAN for the VAP interface  
IC-W-VA  
P
5.23.1 vlan  
This command enables VLANs for all traffic. Use the no form to disable VLANs.  
Syntax  
[no] vlan enable  
Default  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Description  
• When VLANs are enabled, the AP tags frames received from wireless clients with the VLAN ID  
configured for each client on the RADIUS server. If the VLAN ID has not been configured for a  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
client on the RADIUS server, then the frames are tagged with the AP’s native VLAN ID.  
• Traffic entering the Ethernet port must be tagged with a VLAN ID that matches the AP’s native  
VLAN ID, or with a VLAN tag that matches one of the wireless clients currently associated with  
the AP.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#vlan enable  
Reboot system now? <y/n>: y  
Related Commands  
5.23.2 management-vlanid  
This command configures the management VLAN ID for the AP.  
Syntax  
management-vlanid <vlan-id>  
vlan-id - Management VLAN ID. (Range: 1-4094)  
Default Setting  
1
Command Mode  
Global Configuration  
Command Usage  
The management VLAN is for managing the AP. For example, the AP allows traffic that is tagged  
with the specified VLAN to manage the AP via remote management, SSH, SNMP, Telnet, etc.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(config)#management-vlanid 3  
Enterprise AP(config)#  
Related Commands  
5.23.3 vlan-id  
This command configures the default VLAN ID for the VAP interface.  
Syntax  
vlan-id <vlan-id>  
vlan-id - Native VLAN ID. (Range: 1-4094)  
Default Setting  
1
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless-VAP)  
Command Usage  
• To implement the default VLAN ID setting for VAP interface, the AP must enable VLAN support  
using the vlan command.  
248  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
VLAN Commands  
• When VLANs are enabled, the AP tags frames received from wireless clients with the default  
VLAN ID for the VAP interface. If IEEE 802.1X is being used to authenticate wireless clients,  
specific VLAN IDs can be configured on the RADIUS server to be assigned to each client. Using  
IEEE 802.1X and a central RADIUS server, up to 64 VLAN IDs can be mapped to specific  
wireless clients.  
• If the VLAN ID has not been configured for a client on the RADIUS server, then the frames are  
tagged with the default VLAN ID of the VAP interface.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#vlan-id 3  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g: VAP[0])#  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
5.24 WMM Commands  
The AP implements QoS using the WiFi Multimedia (WMM) standard. Using  
WMM, the AP is able to prioritize traffic and optimize performance when multiple  
applications compete for wireless network bandwidth at the same time. WMM  
employs techniques that are a subset of the developing IEEE 802.11e QoS  
standard and it enables the AP to inter-operate with both WMM- enabled clients  
and other devices that may lack any WMM functionality.  
The WMM commands supported by the AP are listed below.  
Table 5-22: WMM Commands  
Command  
Function  
Mode  
IC-W  
IC-W  
Page  
wmm  
Sets the WMM operational mode on the AP  
wmm-acknowledge-  
policy  
Allows the acknowledgement wait time to be enabled or  
disabled for each Access Category (AC)  
wmmparam  
Configures detailed WMM parameters that apply to the AP  
(AP) or the wireless clients (BSS)  
IC-W  
5.24.1 wmm  
This command sets the WMM operational mode on the AP. Use the no form to  
disable WMM.  
Syntax  
[no] wmm <supported | required>  
supported - WMM will be used for any associated device that supports this feature. Devices that  
do not support this feature may still associate with the AP.  
required - WMM must be supported on any device trying to associated with the AP. Devices that  
do not support this feature will not be allowed to associate with the AP.  
Default  
supported  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#wmm required  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.24.2 wmm-acknowledge-policy  
This command allows the acknowledgement wait time to be enabled or disabled  
for each Access Category (AC).  
250  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
WMM Commands  
Syntax  
wmm-acknowledge-policy <ac_number> <ack | noack>  
ac_number - Access categories. (Range: 0-3)  
ack - Require the sender to wait for an acknowledgement from the receiver.  
noack - Does not require the sender to wait for an acknowledgement from the receiver.  
Default  
ack  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Command Usage  
• WMM defines four access categories (ACs) – voice, video, best effort, and background. These  
categories correspond to traffic priority levels and are mapped to IEEE 802.1D priority tags (see  
Table 4-5). The direct mapping of the four ACs to 802.1D priorities is specifically intended to  
facilitate interpretability with other wired network QoS policies. While the four ACs are specified  
for specific types of traffic, WMM allows the priority levels to be configured to match any  
network-wide QoS policy. WMM also specifies a protocol that APs can use to communicate the  
configured traffic priority levels to QoS-enabled wireless clients.  
• Although turning off the requirement for the sender to wait for an acknowledgement can increases  
data throughput, it can also result in a high number of errors when traffic levels are heavy.  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#wmm-acknowledge-policy 0 noack  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
5.24.3 wmmparam  
This command configures detailed WMM parameters that apply to the AP (AP) or  
the wireless clients (BSS).  
Syntax  
wmmparam <AP | BSS> <ac_number> <LogCwMin> <LogCwMax> <AIFS> <TxOpLimit>  
<admission_control>  
AP - Access Point  
BSS - Wireless client  
ac_number - Access categories (ACs) – voice, video, best effort, and background. These  
categories correspond to traffic priority levels and are mapped to IEEE 802.1D priority tags as  
shown in Table 4-5. (Range: 0-3)  
LogCwMin - Minimum log value of the contention window. This is the initial upper limit of the  
random backoff wait time before wireless medium access can be attempted. The initial wait time  
is a random value between zero and the LogCwMin value. Specify the LogCwMin value. Note that  
the LogCwMin value must be equal or less than the LogCwMax value.  
(Range: 1-15 microseconds)  
LogCwMax - Maximum log value of the contention window. This is the maximum upper limit of  
the random backoff wait time before wireless medium access can be attempted. The contention  
window is doubled after each detected collision up to the LogCwMax value. Note that the CWMax  
value must be greater or equal to the LogCwMin value. (Range: 1-15 microseconds)  
AIFS - Arbitrary InterFrame Space specifies the minimum amount of wait time before the next  
data transmission attempt. (Range: 1-15 microseconds)  
TXOPLimit - Transmission Opportunity Limit specifies the maximum time an AC transmit queue  
has access to the wireless medium. When an AC queue is granted a transmit opportunity, it can  
transmit data for a time up to the TxOpLimit. This data bursting greatly improves the efficiency for  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 - Command Line Interface  
high data-rate traffic. (Range: 0-65535 microseconds)  
admission_control - The admission control mode for the access category. When enabled, clients  
are blocked from using the access category. (Options: 0 to disable, 1 to enable)  
Default  
Table 5-23: AP Parameters  
AC0 (Best Effort) AC1 AC2 (Video)  
WMM  
AC3 (Voice)  
Parameters  
(Background)  
LogCwMin  
LogCwMax  
AIFS  
4
4
3
2
10  
10  
4
3
3
7
2
2
TXOP Limit  
Admission Control  
0
0
94  
47  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Table 5-24: BSS Parameters  
WMM  
Parameters  
AC0 (Best Effort) AC1  
(Background)  
AC2 (Video)  
AC3 (Voice)  
LogCwMin  
LogCwMax  
AIFS  
4
4
3
2
6
10  
4
3
3
7
1
1
TXOP Limit  
Admission Control  
0
0
94  
47  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Command Mode  
Interface Configuration (Wireless)  
Example  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#wmmparams ap 0 4 6 3 1 1  
Enterprise AP(if-wireless g)#  
252  
Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A
Appendix A - Troubleshooting  
In This Chapter:  
This appendix provides a lists of things to check in case of problems before  
contacting local Technical Support.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix A -Troubleshooting  
Check the following before you contact local Technical Support.  
1
If wireless clients cannot access the network, check the following:  
Be sure the AP and the wireless clients are configured with the same  
Service Set ID (SSID).  
If authentication or encryption are enabled, ensure that the wireless clients  
are properly configured with the appropriate authentication or encryption  
keys.  
If authentication is being performed through a RADIUS server, ensure that  
the clients are properly configured on the RADIUS server.  
If authentication is being performed through IEEE 802.1X, be sure the  
wireless users have installed and properly configured 802.1X client  
software.  
If MAC address filtering is enabled, be sure the client’s address is included  
in the local filtering database or on the RADIUS server database.  
If the wireless clients are roaming between access points, make sure that  
all the access points and wireless devices in the Extended Service Set (ESS)  
are configured to the same SSID, and authentication method.  
2
If the AP cannot be configured using the Telnet, a web browser, or SNMP  
software:  
Be sure that the AP has been configured with a valid IP address, subnet  
mask and default gateway.  
If VLANs are enabled on the AP, the management station should be  
configured to send tagged frames with a VLAN ID that matches the AP’s  
management VLAN (default VLAN 1, page 64). However, to manage the AP  
from a wireless client, the AP Management Filter should be disabled (page  
61).  
Check that you have a valid network connection to the AP and that the  
Ethernet port or the wireless interface that you are using has not been  
disabled.  
If you are connecting to the AP through the wired Ethernet interface, check  
the network cabling between the management station and the access  
point. If you are connecting to AP from a wireless client, ensure that you  
have a valid connection to the AP.  
254  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A -Troubleshooting  
If you cannot connect using Telnet, you may have exceeded the maximum  
number of concurrent Telnet sessions permitted (i.e, four sessions). Try  
connecting again at a later time.  
3
4
5
If you cannot access the on-board configuration program via a serial port  
connection:  
Be sure you have set the terminal emulator program to VT100 compatible,  
8 data bits, 1 stop bit, no parity and 9600 bps.  
If you forgot or lost the password:  
Set the AP to its default configuration by pressing the reset button on the  
back panel for 5 seconds or more. Then use the default user name admin  
and a null password to access the management interface.  
If all other recovery measure fail, and the AP is still not functioning properly,  
take one of the following steps:  
Reset the AP’s hardware using the console interface, web interface, or  
through a power reset.  
Reset the AP to its default configuration by pressing the reset button on the  
back panel for 5 seconds or more. Then use the default user name admin  
and a null password to access the management interface.  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
100BASE-TX  
10BASE-T  
IEEE 802.3u specification for 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet over two  
pairs of Category 5 or better UTP cable.  
IEEE 802.3 specification for 10 Mbps Ethernet over two pairs  
of Category 3 or better UTP cable  
AES  
Advanced Encryption Standard: An encryption algorithm that  
implements symmetric key cryptography. AES provides very  
strong encryption using a completely different ciphering  
algorithm to TKIP and WEP.  
AP  
Access Point: The device that acts as a communication hub,  
connecting wireless clients to the network.  
Authentication  
The process to verify the identity of a client requesting network  
access. IEEE 802.11 specifies two forms of authentication:  
open system and shared key.  
Beacon  
A signal periodically transmitted from the access point that is  
used to identify the service set, and to maintain contact with  
wireless clients.  
Broadcast Key  
Broadcast keys are sent to stations using 802.1X dynamic  
keying. Dynamic broadcast key rotation is often used to allow  
the access point to generate a random group key and  
periodically update all key-management capable wireless  
clients.  
BSS  
Basic Service Set: A set of 802.11-compliant stations and an  
access point that operate as a fully-connected wireless  
network.  
CPE  
Customer Premise Equipment: Communications equipment  
that resides on the customer's premises.  
CSMA/CA  
Carrier Sense Multiple Access with Collision Avoidance  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Glossary  
DHCP  
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol: Provides a framework for  
passing configuration information to hosts on a TCP/IP  
network. DHCP is based on the Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP),  
adding the capability of automatic allocation of reusable  
network addresses and additional configuration options.  
EAP  
ESS  
Extensible Authentication Protocol: An authentication protocol  
used to authenticate network clients. EAP is combined with  
IEEE 802.1X port authentication and a RADIUS  
authentication server to provide “mutual authentication”  
between a client, the Wi², and a RADIUS server.  
Extended Service Set: More than one wireless cell can be  
configured with the same Service Set Identifier to allow mobile  
users can roam between different cells with the Extended  
Service Set.  
FTP  
File Transfer Protocol: A TCP/IP protocol used for file transfer.  
HTTP  
Hypertext Transfer Protocol: HTTP is a standard used to  
transmit and receive all data over the World Wide Web.  
IAPP  
Inter Access Point Protocol: A protocol that specifies the  
wireless signaling required to ensure the successful handover  
of wireless clients roaming between different  
802.11f-compliant Wi²s.  
IEEE 802.11b  
IEEE 802.11g  
A wireless standard that supports wireless communications in  
the 2.4 GHz band using Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum  
(DSSS). The standard provides for data rates of 1, 2, 5.5, and  
11 Mbps.  
A wireless standard that supports wireless communications in  
the 2.4 GHz band using using Orthogonal Frequency Division  
Multiplexing (OFDM). The standard provides for data rates of  
6, 9, 11, 12, 18, 24, 36, 48, 54 Mbps. IEEE 802.11g is also  
backward compatible with IEEE 802.11b.  
IEEE 802.1X  
LAN  
Port Authentication controls access to the switch ports by  
requiring users to first enter a user ID and password for  
authentication.  
Local Area Network: A group of interconnected computer and  
support devices.  
258  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
MAC  
Media Access Control: The lower of the two sub-layers of the  
data link layer defined by the IEEE. The MAC sub-layer  
handles access to shared media, such as whether token  
passing or contention will be used.  
MAC Address  
Standardized data link layer address that is required for every  
port or device that connects to a LAN. Other devices in the  
network use these addresses to locate specific ports in the  
network and to create and update routing tables and data  
structures. MAC addresses are 6bytes long and are controlled  
by the IEEE.  
NTP  
Network Time Protocol: NTP provides the mechanisms to  
synchronize time across the network. The time servers operate  
in a hierarchical-master-slave configuration in order to  
synchronize local clocks within the subnet and to national time  
standards via wire or radio.  
ODFM  
Orthogonal Frequency Division Multiplexing: OFDM/ allows  
multiple users to transmit in an allocated band by dividing the  
bandwidth into many narrow bandwidth carriers.  
Open System  
A security option for the AP which broadcasts a beacon signal  
including the configured SSID. Wireless clients can read the  
SSID from the beacon, and automatically reset their SSID to  
allow immediate connection to the nearest AP.  
PoE  
PSK  
Power over Ethernet: A specification for providing both power  
and data to low-power network devices using a single Category  
5 Ethernet cable. PoE provides greater flexibility in the locating  
of Wi²s and network devices, and significantly decreased  
installation costs.  
WPA Pre-shared Key: PSK can be used for small office  
networks that may not have the resources to configure and  
maintain a RADIUS server, WPA provides a simple operating  
mode that uses just a pre-shared password for network access.  
RADIUS  
Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service: A logon  
authentication protocol that uses software running on a  
central server to control access to the network.  
Session Key  
Session keys are unique to each client, and are used to  
authenticate a client connection, and correlate traffic passing  
between a specific client and the Wi².  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
Shared Key  
A shared key can be used to authenticate each client attached  
to a wireless network. Shared Key authentication must be used  
along with the 802.11 Wireless Equivalent Privacy algorithm.  
SNMP  
SNTP  
Simple Network Management Protocol: The application  
protocol in the Internet suite of protocols which offers network  
management services.  
Simple Network Time Protocol: SNTP allows a device to set its  
internal clock based on periodic updates from a Network Time  
Protocol (NTP) server. Updates can be requested from a specific  
NTP server, or can be received via broadcasts sent by NTP  
servers.  
SSID  
Service Set Identifier: An identifier that is attached to packets  
sent over the wireless LAN and functions as a password for  
joining a particular radio cell; i.e., Basic Service Set (BSS).  
SU-IDU  
SU-ODU  
TFTP  
Subscriber Indoor Unit  
Subscriber Outdoor Unit  
Trivial File Transfer Protocol: A TCP/IP protocol commonly  
used for software downloads.  
TKIP  
Temporal Key Integrity Protocol: A data encryption method  
designed as a replacement for WEP. TKIP avoids the problems  
of WEP static keys by dynamically changing data encryption  
keys.  
VAP  
Virtual Access Point: Virtual AP technology multiplies the  
number of Access Points present within the RF footprint of a  
single physical access device. With Virtual AP technology,  
WLAN users within the device’s footprint can associate with  
what appears to be different Wi²s and their associated network  
services. All the services are delivered using a single radio  
channel, enabling Virtual AP technology to optimize the use of  
limited WLAN radio spectrum.  
VLAN  
Virtual Local Area Network: A group of devices on one or more  
LANs that are configured with the same VLAN ID so that they  
can communicate as if they were attached to the same wire,  
when in fact they are located on a number of different LAN  
segments. Used also to create separation between different  
user groups.  
260  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
WEP  
WPA  
Wired Equivalent Privacy: WEP is based on the use of security  
keys and the popular RC4 encryption algorithm. Wireless  
devices without a valid WEP key will be excluded from network  
traffic.  
WiFi Protected Access: WPA employs 802.1X as its basic  
framework for user authentication and dynamic key  
management to provide an enhanced security solution for  
802.11 wireless networks.  
.
.
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS Wi² System Manual  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Numerics  
802.11g 5-215  
D
device status, displaying 5-153  
A
authentication 4-57  
cipher suite 4-116, 5-236  
closed system 5-225  
configuring 4-57  
downloading software 4-69, 5-185  
MAC address 4-58, 5-198, 5-199  
web redirect 4-59  
E
encryption 4-102, 4-109, 4-112  
event logs 4-124, 5-164  
external antenna 2-31  
B
beacon  
interval 4-94, 5-221  
F
factory defaults  
C
restoring 4-72, 5-141  
filter 4-61, 5-198  
Clear To Send See CTS  
address 4-57, 5-198  
between wireless clients 5-203  
local bridge 5-203  
command modes 5-133  
closed system 4-87, 5-225  
community name, configuring 4-79, 5-172  
community string 4-80, 5-172  
configuration settings, saving or restoring 4-72,  
local or remote 4-57, 5-200  
management access 4-62, 5-203  
protocol types 4-63, 5-204  
VLANs 4-87, 5-247  
firmware  
configuration, initial setup 3-35  
console port  
displaying version 4-71, 5-154  
upgrading 4-69, 4-71, 5-185  
fragmentation 5-223  
required settings 3-37  
country code  
configuring 3-38, 5-144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
G
P
gateway address 3-38, 4-51, 5-130, 5-210  
grounding cables 2-31  
password  
configuring 4-68, 4-69, 4-71, 5-147  
management 4-68, 4-69, 4-71, 5-147  
pin assignment  
H
Ethernet connector 2-24  
power cable 2-26  
power source  
hardware version, displaying 5-154  
HTTP, secure server 5-151  
HTTPS 5-150  
connecting to 2-31  
I
R
IEEE 802.11b 4-85  
RADIUS, logon authentication 4-59, 5-189  
RADIUS  
IEEE 802.11f 5-246  
IEEE 802.11g 4-85  
configuring interface 4-85, 5-215  
IEEE 802.1x 4-112, 5-195, 5-198  
configuring 4-118, 5-195  
initial setup 3-35  
reset 4-72, 5-141  
reset button 4-72  
IP address  
resetting the access point 4-72, 5-141  
restarting the system 4-72, 5-141  
RJ-45 port  
BOOTP/DHCP 5-210, 5-211  
configuring 3-38, 4-49, 5-210, 5-211  
configuring duplex mode 5-211  
configuring speed 5-211  
RTS  
L
log  
messages 4-75, 4-124, 5-161  
server 4-74, 5-161  
login  
threshold 4-95, 5-223  
S
logon authentication  
sealing cap 2-22  
security, options 4-102, 4-103  
session key 4-118  
shared key 4-110, 5-237  
RADIUS client 4-59, 5-189  
M
MAC address, authentication 4-58, 5-198, 5-199  
mounting plate  
attaching SU-ODU 2-19  
attaching to unit 2-21  
community name 4-79, 5-172  
community string 5-172  
enabling traps 4-80, 5-174  
trap destination 4-80, 5-174  
trap manager 4-80, 5-174  
O
open system 4-102, 5-225  
264  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS VL Wi² System Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
time zone 4-77, 5-168  
transmit power, configuring 5-218  
trap destination 4-80, 5-174  
trap manager 4-80, 5-174  
troubleshooting A-253  
enabling client 4-76, 5-167  
server 4-76, 5-166  
software  
displaying version 4-69, 4-120, 5-154  
downloading 4-71, 5-185  
SSH  
server Status 4-56  
U
upgrading software 4-69, 5-185  
user name, manager 4-68, 5-146  
user password 4-68, 5-146, 5-147  
startup files, setting 5-185  
station status 4-122, 5-229  
status  
V
displaying device status 5-153  
displaying station status 4-122, 5-229  
system clock, setting 4-76, 5-167  
system log  
VLAN  
configuration 4-87, 5-247  
native ID 4-87  
enabling 4-74, 5-161  
server 4-74, 5-161  
system software, downloading from server 4-69,  
W
configuring 4-108  
shared key 4-110, 5-237  
T
Telnet  
for managenet access 5-129  
tilt accessory 2-28  
pre-shared key 4-116, 5-240  
tilt angle 2-22  
BreezeMAX Wi² and BreezeACCESS VL Wi² System Manual  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Abocom Network Card WCB5202 User Manual
Acer Computer Monitor SG336 0005A User Manual
Agri Fab Spreader 45 02113 User Manual
Alcatel Lucent IP Phone OmniGenesys User Manual
Alienware Personal Computer D0IX User Manual
Alto Shaam Oven 610ESi User Manual
Audiovox Automobile Alarm CA 6552 User Manual
Avocent Switch DSR1022 User Manual
Azden Headphones SGM PII User Manual
Beckett Water Gardening Plumbing Product M250A User Manual